2010-02-24 Phil Muldoon <pmuldoon@redhat.com>
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GDB.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include "arch-utils.h"
24 #include <ctype.h>
25 #include "hashtab.h"
26 #include "symtab.h"
27 #include "frame.h"
28 #include "breakpoint.h"
29 #include "tracepoint.h"
30 #include "gdbtypes.h"
31 #include "expression.h"
32 #include "gdbcore.h"
33 #include "gdbcmd.h"
34 #include "value.h"
35 #include "command.h"
36 #include "inferior.h"
37 #include "gdbthread.h"
38 #include "target.h"
39 #include "language.h"
40 #include "gdb_string.h"
41 #include "demangle.h"
42 #include "annotate.h"
43 #include "symfile.h"
44 #include "objfiles.h"
45 #include "source.h"
46 #include "linespec.h"
47 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "gdb.h"
49 #include "ui-out.h"
50 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
51 #include "gdb_assert.h"
52 #include "block.h"
53 #include "solib.h"
54 #include "solist.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "exceptions.h"
57 #include "memattr.h"
58 #include "ada-lang.h"
59 #include "top.h"
60 #include "wrapper.h"
61 #include "valprint.h"
62 #include "jit.h"
63 #include "xml-syscall.h"
64
65 /* readline include files */
66 #include "readline/readline.h"
67 #include "readline/history.h"
68
69 /* readline defines this. */
70 #undef savestring
71
72 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
73
74 /* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers. */
75 #define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
76 #define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
77
78 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
79
80 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
81
82 static void enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
83
84 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
85
86 static void enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
87
88 static void disable_command (char *, int);
89
90 static void enable_command (char *, int);
91
92 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*)(struct breakpoint *));
93
94 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
95
96 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
97
98 static void clear_command (char *, int);
99
100 static void catch_command (char *, int);
101
102 static void watch_command (char *, int);
103
104 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
105
106 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
107
108 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
109
110 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
111 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
112 struct symtab_and_line,
113 enum bptype);
114
115 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
116
117 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
118 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
119 enum bptype bptype);
120
121 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
122 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
123 struct obj_section *, int);
124
125 static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
126 CORE_ADDR addr1,
127 struct address_space *aspace2,
128 CORE_ADDR addr2);
129
130 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
131 struct bp_location *loc2);
132
133 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
134
135 static void breakpoint_1 (int, int);
136
137 static bpstat bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *, bpstat);
138
139 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
140
141 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
142
143 static void commands_command (char *, int);
144
145 static void condition_command (char *, int);
146
147 static int get_number_trailer (char **, int);
148
149 void set_breakpoint_count (int);
150
151 typedef enum
152 {
153 mark_inserted,
154 mark_uninserted
155 }
156 insertion_state_t;
157
158 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
159 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
160
161 static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
162
163 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
164
165 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
166
167 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
168
169 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
170
171 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
172
173 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
174
175 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
176
177 static void watch_command_1 (char *, int, int);
178
179 static void rwatch_command (char *, int);
180
181 static void awatch_command (char *, int);
182
183 static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
184
185 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
186
187 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
188
189 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
190
191 static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
192
193 static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
194 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
195
196 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
197
198 static void ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s);
199
200 static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
201 CORE_ADDR pc);
202
203 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
204
205 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
206
207 static void update_global_location_list (int);
208
209 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
210
211 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
212
213 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
214
215 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
216
217 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
218
219 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
220
221 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
222
223 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
224
225 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
226
227 static void skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal);
228
229
230 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
231 current breakpoint. */
232
233 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
234
235 static const char *
236 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
237 {
238 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and represent
239 values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at a breakpoint. */
240 static char *bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
241 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
242 }
243
244 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
245 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
246 if such is available. */
247 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
248
249 static void
250 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
251 struct cmd_list_element *c,
252 const char *value)
253 {
254 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
255 Debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
256 value);
257 }
258
259 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
260 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
261 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
262 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
263 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
264 static void
265 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
266 struct cmd_list_element *c,
267 const char *value)
268 {
269 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
270 Debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
271 value);
272 }
273
274 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
275 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
276 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
277 use hardware breakpoints. */
278 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
279 static void
280 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
281 struct cmd_list_element *c,
282 const char *value)
283 {
284 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
285 Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
286 value);
287 }
288
289 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
290 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
291 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
292 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
293 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
294
295 static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
296 static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
297 static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
298 static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
299 always_inserted_auto,
300 always_inserted_off,
301 always_inserted_on,
302 NULL
303 };
304 static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
305 static void
306 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
307 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
308 {
309 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
310 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
311 Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
312 value,
313 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
314 else
315 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), value);
316 }
317
318 int
319 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
320 {
321 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
322 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
323 }
324
325 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
326
327 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
328 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
329
330 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
331 static int overlay_events_enabled;
332
333 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
334 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the current
335 breakpoint. */
336
337 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
338
339 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
340 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
341 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
342 B = TMP)
343
344 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is not
345 provided so update_global_location_list must not be called while executing
346 the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
347
348 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
349 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
350 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
351 BP_TMP++)
352
353 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
354
355 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
356 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
357 if (tracepoint_type (B))
358
359 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
360
361 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
362
363 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
364
365 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
366
367 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
368
369 static unsigned bp_location_count;
370
371 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and ADDRESS
372 for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
373 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
374 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
375
376 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
377
378 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between
379 bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for
380 the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
381 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
382 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
383
384 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
385
386 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint,
387 unlinked from bp_location array, but for which a hit
388 may still be reported by a target. */
389 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
390
391 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
392
393 int breakpoint_count;
394
395 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
396
397 int tracepoint_count;
398
399 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
400 static int
401 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
402 {
403 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
404 }
405
406 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
407
408 void
409 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
410 {
411 breakpoint_count = num;
412 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
413 }
414
415 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
416
417 void
418 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
419 {
420 struct breakpoint *b;
421
422 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
423 b->hit_count = 0;
424 }
425
426 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
427
428 static int
429 tracepoint_type (const struct breakpoint *b)
430 {
431 return (b->type == bp_tracepoint || b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint);
432 }
433
434 /* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
435 for "break" command with no arg.
436 if default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
437 not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
438
439 This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint. */
440
441 int default_breakpoint_valid;
442 CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
443 struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
444 int default_breakpoint_line;
445 struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
446
447 \f
448 /* *PP is a string denoting a breakpoint. Get the number of the breakpoint.
449 Advance *PP after the string and any trailing whitespace.
450
451 Currently the string can either be a number or "$" followed by the name
452 of a convenience variable. Making it an expression wouldn't work well
453 for map_breakpoint_numbers (e.g. "4 + 5 + 6").
454
455 If the string is a NULL pointer, that denotes the last breakpoint.
456
457 TRAILER is a character which can be found after the number; most
458 commonly this is `-'. If you don't want a trailer, use \0. */
459 static int
460 get_number_trailer (char **pp, int trailer)
461 {
462 int retval = 0; /* default */
463 char *p = *pp;
464
465 if (p == NULL)
466 /* Empty line means refer to the last breakpoint. */
467 return breakpoint_count;
468 else if (*p == '$')
469 {
470 /* Make a copy of the name, so we can null-terminate it
471 to pass to lookup_internalvar(). */
472 char *varname;
473 char *start = ++p;
474 LONGEST val;
475
476 while (isalnum (*p) || *p == '_')
477 p++;
478 varname = (char *) alloca (p - start + 1);
479 strncpy (varname, start, p - start);
480 varname[p - start] = '\0';
481 if (get_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar (varname), &val))
482 retval = (int) val;
483 else
484 {
485 printf_filtered (_("Convenience variable must have integer value.\n"));
486 retval = 0;
487 }
488 }
489 else
490 {
491 if (*p == '-')
492 ++p;
493 while (*p >= '0' && *p <= '9')
494 ++p;
495 if (p == *pp)
496 /* There is no number here. (e.g. "cond a == b"). */
497 {
498 /* Skip non-numeric token */
499 while (*p && !isspace((int) *p))
500 ++p;
501 /* Return zero, which caller must interpret as error. */
502 retval = 0;
503 }
504 else
505 retval = atoi (*pp);
506 }
507 if (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
508 {
509 /* Trailing junk: return 0 and let caller print error msg. */
510 while (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
511 ++p;
512 retval = 0;
513 }
514 while (isspace (*p))
515 p++;
516 *pp = p;
517 return retval;
518 }
519
520
521 /* Like get_number_trailer, but don't allow a trailer. */
522 int
523 get_number (char **pp)
524 {
525 return get_number_trailer (pp, '\0');
526 }
527
528 /* Parse a number or a range.
529 * A number will be of the form handled by get_number.
530 * A range will be of the form <number1> - <number2>, and
531 * will represent all the integers between number1 and number2,
532 * inclusive.
533 *
534 * While processing a range, this fuction is called iteratively;
535 * At each call it will return the next value in the range.
536 *
537 * At the beginning of parsing a range, the char pointer PP will
538 * be advanced past <number1> and left pointing at the '-' token.
539 * Subsequent calls will not advance the pointer until the range
540 * is completed. The call that completes the range will advance
541 * pointer PP past <number2>.
542 */
543
544 int
545 get_number_or_range (char **pp)
546 {
547 static int last_retval, end_value;
548 static char *end_ptr;
549 static int in_range = 0;
550
551 if (**pp != '-')
552 {
553 /* Default case: pp is pointing either to a solo number,
554 or to the first number of a range. */
555 last_retval = get_number_trailer (pp, '-');
556 if (**pp == '-')
557 {
558 char **temp;
559
560 /* This is the start of a range (<number1> - <number2>).
561 Skip the '-', parse and remember the second number,
562 and also remember the end of the final token. */
563
564 temp = &end_ptr;
565 end_ptr = *pp + 1;
566 while (isspace ((int) *end_ptr))
567 end_ptr++; /* skip white space */
568 end_value = get_number (temp);
569 if (end_value < last_retval)
570 {
571 error (_("inverted range"));
572 }
573 else if (end_value == last_retval)
574 {
575 /* degenerate range (number1 == number2). Advance the
576 token pointer so that the range will be treated as a
577 single number. */
578 *pp = end_ptr;
579 }
580 else
581 in_range = 1;
582 }
583 }
584 else if (! in_range)
585 error (_("negative value"));
586 else
587 {
588 /* pp points to the '-' that betokens a range. All
589 number-parsing has already been done. Return the next
590 integer value (one greater than the saved previous value).
591 Do not advance the token pointer 'pp' until the end of range
592 is reached. */
593
594 if (++last_retval == end_value)
595 {
596 /* End of range reached; advance token pointer. */
597 *pp = end_ptr;
598 in_range = 0;
599 }
600 }
601 return last_retval;
602 }
603
604 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
605 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
606
607 struct breakpoint *
608 get_breakpoint (int num)
609 {
610 struct breakpoint *b;
611
612 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
613 if (b->number == num)
614 return b;
615
616 return NULL;
617 }
618
619 \f
620 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
621
622 static void
623 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
624 {
625 struct breakpoint *b;
626 char *p;
627 int bnum;
628
629 if (arg == 0)
630 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
631
632 p = arg;
633 bnum = get_number (&p);
634 if (bnum == 0)
635 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
636
637 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
638 if (b->number == bnum)
639 {
640 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
641 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
642 {
643 if (loc->cond)
644 {
645 xfree (loc->cond);
646 loc->cond = 0;
647 }
648 }
649 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
650 xfree (b->cond_string);
651
652 if (*p == 0)
653 {
654 b->cond_string = NULL;
655 if (from_tty)
656 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), bnum);
657 }
658 else
659 {
660 arg = p;
661 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
662 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
663 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
664 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
665 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
666 {
667 arg = p;
668 loc->cond =
669 parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
670 if (*arg)
671 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
672 }
673 }
674 breakpoints_changed ();
675 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
676 return;
677 }
678
679 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
680 }
681
682 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. */
683
684 void
685 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, struct command_line *commands)
686 {
687 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
688 b->commands = commands;
689 breakpoints_changed ();
690 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
691 }
692
693 static void
694 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
695 {
696 struct breakpoint *b;
697 char *p;
698 int bnum;
699 struct command_line *l;
700
701 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
702 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
703 being read from. */
704
705 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
706 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
707
708 p = arg;
709 bnum = get_number (&p);
710
711 if (p && *p)
712 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
713
714 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
715 if (b->number == bnum)
716 {
717 char *tmpbuf = xstrprintf ("Type commands for when breakpoint %d is hit, one per line.",
718 bnum);
719 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, tmpbuf);
720 l = read_command_lines (tmpbuf, from_tty, 1);
721 do_cleanups (cleanups);
722 breakpoint_set_commands (b, l);
723 return;
724 }
725 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
726 }
727
728 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
729 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
730
731 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
732 that are part of if and while bodies. */
733 enum command_control_type
734 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
735 {
736 struct breakpoint *b;
737 char *p;
738 int bnum;
739
740 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
741 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
742 being read from. */
743
744 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
745 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
746
747 /* An empty string for the breakpoint number means the last
748 breakpoint, but get_number expects a NULL pointer. */
749 if (arg && !*arg)
750 p = NULL;
751 else
752 p = arg;
753 bnum = get_number (&p);
754
755 if (p && *p)
756 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
757
758 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
759 if (b->number == bnum)
760 {
761 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
762 if (cmd->body_count != 1)
763 error (_("Invalid \"commands\" block structure."));
764 /* We need to copy the commands because if/while will free the
765 list after it finishes execution. */
766 b->commands = copy_command_lines (cmd->body_list[0]);
767 breakpoints_changed ();
768 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
769 return simple_control;
770 }
771 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
772 }
773
774 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
775
776 static int
777 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
778 {
779 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
780 return 0;
781 if (!bl->inserted)
782 return 0;
783 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
784 /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
785 return 0;
786 return 1;
787 }
788
789 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
790 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
791
792 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
793 b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
794 up to b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
795 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
796 memaddr ... memaddr + len
797 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
798 memaddr + len <= b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
799 and:
800 b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
801
802 void
803 breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
804 {
805 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary search. */
806 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
807
808 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF content. It is
809 safe to report lower value but a failure to report higher one. */
810
811 bc_l = 0;
812 bc_r = bp_location_count;
813 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
814 {
815 struct bp_location *b;
816
817 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
818 b = bp_location[bc];
819
820 /* Check first B->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added constant.
821 Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure the BC element can
822 in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR to MEMADDR + LEN range).
823
824 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety offset so that
825 we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow range tail still reaching
826 MEMADDR. */
827
828 if (b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max >= b->address
829 && b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr)
830 bc_l = bc;
831 else
832 bc_r = bc;
833 }
834
835 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
836
837 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
838 {
839 struct bp_location *b = bp_location[bc];
840 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
841 int bp_size = 0;
842 int bptoffset = 0;
843
844 if (b->owner->type == bp_none)
845 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
846 b->owner->number);
847
848 /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
849 content. */
850
851 if (b->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
852 && memaddr + len <= b->address
853 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
854 break;
855
856 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (b))
857 continue;
858 if (!breakpoint_address_match (b->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
859 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
860 continue;
861
862 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
863 we need to copy. */
864 bp_addr = b->target_info.placed_address;
865 bp_size = b->target_info.shadow_len;
866
867 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
868 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
869 are reading. */
870 continue;
871
872 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
873 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
874 reading. */
875 continue;
876
877 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
878 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
879 {
880 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
881 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
882 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
883 bp_addr = memaddr;
884 }
885
886 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
887 {
888 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
889 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
890 }
891
892 memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
893 b->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
894 }
895 }
896 \f
897
898 /* A wrapper function for inserting catchpoints. */
899 static void
900 insert_catchpoint (struct ui_out *uo, void *args)
901 {
902 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) args;
903 int val = -1;
904
905 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
906 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->insert != NULL);
907
908 b->ops->insert (b);
909 }
910
911 static int
912 is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
913 {
914 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
915 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
916 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
917 }
918
919 /* Find the current value of a watchpoint on EXP. Return the value in
920 *VALP and *RESULTP and the chain of intermediate and final values
921 in *VAL_CHAIN. RESULTP and VAL_CHAIN may be NULL if the caller does
922 not need them.
923
924 If a memory error occurs while evaluating the expression, *RESULTP will
925 be set to NULL. *RESULTP may be a lazy value, if the result could
926 not be read from memory. It is used to determine whether a value
927 is user-specified (we should watch the whole value) or intermediate
928 (we should watch only the bit used to locate the final value).
929
930 If the final value, or any intermediate value, could not be read
931 from memory, *VALP will be set to NULL. *VAL_CHAIN will still be
932 set to any referenced values. *VALP will never be a lazy value.
933 This is the value which we store in struct breakpoint.
934
935 If VAL_CHAIN is non-NULL, *VAL_CHAIN will be released from the
936 value chain. The caller must free the values individually. If
937 VAL_CHAIN is NULL, all generated values will be left on the value
938 chain. */
939
940 static void
941 fetch_watchpoint_value (struct expression *exp, struct value **valp,
942 struct value **resultp, struct value **val_chain)
943 {
944 struct value *mark, *new_mark, *result;
945 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
946
947 *valp = NULL;
948 if (resultp)
949 *resultp = NULL;
950 if (val_chain)
951 *val_chain = NULL;
952
953 /* Evaluate the expression. */
954 mark = value_mark ();
955 result = NULL;
956
957 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
958 {
959 result = evaluate_expression (exp);
960 }
961 if (ex.reason < 0)
962 {
963 /* Ignore memory errors, we want watchpoints pointing at
964 inaccessible memory to still be created; otherwise, throw the
965 error to some higher catcher. */
966 switch (ex.error)
967 {
968 case MEMORY_ERROR:
969 break;
970 default:
971 throw_exception (ex);
972 break;
973 }
974 }
975
976 new_mark = value_mark ();
977 if (mark == new_mark)
978 return;
979 if (resultp)
980 *resultp = result;
981
982 /* Make sure it's not lazy, so that after the target stops again we
983 have a non-lazy previous value to compare with. */
984 if (result != NULL
985 && (!value_lazy (result) || gdb_value_fetch_lazy (result)))
986 *valp = result;
987
988 if (val_chain)
989 {
990 /* Return the chain of intermediate values. We use this to
991 decide which addresses to watch. */
992 *val_chain = new_mark;
993 value_release_to_mark (mark);
994 }
995 }
996
997 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
998 and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
999 Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
1000 context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
1001 created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
1002 the correct frame context. Watchpoints on global expressions can
1003 be evaluated on any thread, and in any state. It is presently left
1004 to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
1005 running. */
1006
1007 static int
1008 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1009 {
1010 return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1011 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1012 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1013 }
1014
1015 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1016 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1017 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1018 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1019 in b->loc->cond.
1020 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1021
1022 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do nothing.
1023 If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete it.
1024
1025 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are removed
1026 + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must never be removed
1027 because they might be missed by a running thread when debugging in non-stop
1028 mode. On the other hand, hardware watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint;
1029 processed here) are specific to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's
1030 hardware debug registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in
1031 order to be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1032
1033 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being presented to the
1034 user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would reset the data used to
1035 present the watchpoint hit to the user. And it must not be done later
1036 because it could display the same single watchpoint hit during multiple GDB
1037 stops. Note that the latter is relevant only to the hardware watchpoint
1038 types bp_read_watchpoint and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by
1039 bp_hardware_watchpoint is not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the
1040 memory content has not changed.
1041
1042 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset hardware
1043 watchpoints:
1044
1045 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are called
1046 several times when GDB stops.
1047
1048 [linux]
1049 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, causing GDB to
1050 stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint hit at a time as the
1051 reason for stopping, and all the other hits are presented later, one after
1052 the other, each time the user requests the execution to be resumed.
1053 Execution is not resumed for the threads still having pending hit event
1054 stored in LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1055 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being reported
1056 from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address until the real
1057 thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets presented and thus its
1058 LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1059
1060 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the watchpoint
1061 removal from inferior. */
1062
1063 static void
1064 update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1065 {
1066 int within_current_scope;
1067 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1068 struct bp_location *loc;
1069 int frame_saved;
1070 bpstat bs;
1071
1072 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1073 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1074 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1075 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1076 return;
1077
1078 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in bp_location array and
1079 update_global_locations will eventually delete them and remove
1080 breakpoints if needed. */
1081 b->loc = NULL;
1082
1083 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1084 return;
1085
1086 frame_saved = 0;
1087
1088 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1089 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1090 within_current_scope = 1;
1091 else
1092 {
1093 struct frame_info *fi;
1094
1095 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1096 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1097 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1098 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1099 selected frame. */
1100 frame_saved = 1;
1101 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1102
1103 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1104 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1105 if (within_current_scope)
1106 select_frame (fi);
1107 }
1108
1109 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1110 {
1111 char *s;
1112 if (b->exp)
1113 {
1114 xfree (b->exp);
1115 b->exp = NULL;
1116 }
1117 s = b->exp_string;
1118 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1119 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1120 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1121 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1122 be completely different objects. */
1123 value_free (b->val);
1124 b->val = NULL;
1125 b->val_valid = 0;
1126 }
1127
1128 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1129 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1130 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1131 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1132 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1133 if ( !target_has_execution)
1134 {
1135 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1136 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1137 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1138 }
1139 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1140 {
1141 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1142 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1143
1144 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1145
1146 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1147 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1148 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1149 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. */
1150 if (!b->val_valid)
1151 {
1152 b->val = v;
1153 b->val_valid = 1;
1154 }
1155
1156 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or an
1157 ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and free
1158 hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior is started. */
1159 if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1160 && reparse)
1161 {
1162 int i, mem_cnt, other_type_used;
1163
1164 /* We need to determine how many resources are already used
1165 for all other hardware watchpoints to see if we still have
1166 enough resources to also fit this watchpoint in as well.
1167 To avoid the hw_watchpoint_used_count call below from counting
1168 this watchpoint, make sure that it is marked as a software
1169 watchpoint. */
1170 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1171 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1172 &other_type_used);
1173 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1174
1175 if (!mem_cnt)
1176 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1177 else
1178 {
1179 int target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1180 (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i + mem_cnt, other_type_used);
1181 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1182 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1183 else
1184 b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1185 }
1186 }
1187
1188 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1189
1190 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1191 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1192 {
1193 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1194 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1195 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1196 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1197 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1198 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1199 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1200 {
1201 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1202
1203 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1204 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1205 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1206 if (v == result
1207 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1208 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1209 {
1210 CORE_ADDR addr;
1211 int len, type;
1212 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1213
1214 addr = value_address (v);
1215 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1216 type = hw_write;
1217 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1218 type = hw_read;
1219 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1220 type = hw_access;
1221
1222 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1223 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1224 ;
1225 *tmp = loc;
1226 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1227
1228 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1229 loc->address = addr;
1230 loc->length = len;
1231 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1232 }
1233 }
1234
1235 next = value_next (v);
1236 if (v != b->val)
1237 value_free (v);
1238 }
1239
1240 /* We just regenerated the list of breakpoint locations.
1241 The new location does not have its condition field set to anything
1242 and therefore, we must always reparse the cond_string, independently
1243 of the value of the reparse flag. */
1244 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1245 {
1246 char *s = b->cond_string;
1247 b->loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1248 }
1249 }
1250 else if (!within_current_scope)
1251 {
1252 printf_filtered (_("\
1253 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block \n\
1254 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1255 b->number);
1256 if (b->related_breakpoint)
1257 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1258 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1259 }
1260
1261 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1262 if (frame_saved)
1263 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1264 }
1265
1266
1267 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1268 inserted in the inferior. */
1269 static int
1270 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bpt)
1271 {
1272 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner))
1273 return 0;
1274
1275 if (bpt->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1276 return 0;
1277
1278 if (!bpt->enabled || bpt->shlib_disabled || bpt->duplicate)
1279 return 0;
1280
1281 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1282 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1283 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1284 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1285 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1286 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1287 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1288 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1289 if (bpt->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1290 return 0;
1291
1292 /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1293 not by us. */
1294 if (tracepoint_type (bpt->owner))
1295 return 0;
1296
1297 return 1;
1298 }
1299
1300 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BPT is the breakpoint.
1301 Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and DISABLED_BREAKS,
1302 and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1303
1304 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an object-style
1305 method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
1306 static int
1307 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bpt,
1308 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1309 int *disabled_breaks,
1310 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1311 {
1312 int val = 0;
1313
1314 if (!should_be_inserted (bpt) || bpt->inserted)
1315 return 0;
1316
1317 /* Initialize the target-specific information. */
1318 memset (&bpt->target_info, 0, sizeof (bpt->target_info));
1319 bpt->target_info.placed_address = bpt->address;
1320 bpt->target_info.placed_address_space = bpt->pspace->aspace;
1321
1322 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1323 || bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1324 {
1325 if (bpt->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1326 {
1327 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1328 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1329 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1330 Two important cases are:
1331 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1332 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
1333 hardware breakpoint.
1334 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write.
1335 This means we've previously made the location hardware one, but
1336 then the memory map changed, so we undo.
1337
1338 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will
1339 use location types we've just set here, the only possible
1340 problem is that memory map has changed during running program,
1341 but it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
1342 struct mem_region *mr
1343 = lookup_mem_region (bpt->target_info.placed_address);
1344
1345 if (mr)
1346 {
1347 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1348 {
1349 int changed = 0;
1350 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1351
1352 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1353 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1354 else
1355 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1356
1357 if (new_type != bpt->loc_type)
1358 {
1359 static int said = 0;
1360 bpt->loc_type = new_type;
1361 if (!said)
1362 {
1363 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, _("\
1364 Note: automatically using hardware breakpoints for read-only addresses.\n"));
1365 said = 1;
1366 }
1367 }
1368 }
1369 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1370 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1371 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint at readonly address %s"),
1372 paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address));
1373 }
1374 }
1375
1376 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
1377 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1378 || bpt->section == NULL
1379 || !(section_is_overlay (bpt->section)))
1380 {
1381 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
1382
1383 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1384 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1385 &bpt->target_info);
1386 else
1387 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1388 &bpt->target_info);
1389 }
1390 else
1391 {
1392 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1393 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
1394 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1395 {
1396 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1397 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1398 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
1399 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1400 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1401 bpt->owner->number);
1402 else
1403 {
1404 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bpt->address,
1405 bpt->section);
1406 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
1407 bpt->overlay_target_info = bpt->target_info;
1408 bpt->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1409 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1410 &bpt->overlay_target_info);
1411 if (val != 0)
1412 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1413 "Overlay breakpoint %d failed: in ROM?\n",
1414 bpt->owner->number);
1415 }
1416 }
1417 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1418 if (section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
1419 {
1420 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
1421 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1422 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1423 &bpt->target_info);
1424 else
1425 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1426 &bpt->target_info);
1427 }
1428 else
1429 {
1430 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1431 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
1432 return 0;
1433 }
1434 }
1435
1436 if (val)
1437 {
1438 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
1439 if (solib_name_from_address (bpt->pspace, bpt->address))
1440 {
1441 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1442 val = 0;
1443 bpt->shlib_disabled = 1;
1444 if (!*disabled_breaks)
1445 {
1446 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1447 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1448 bpt->owner->number);
1449 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1450 "Temporarily disabling shared library breakpoints:\n");
1451 }
1452 *disabled_breaks = 1;
1453 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1454 "breakpoint #%d\n", bpt->owner->number);
1455 }
1456 else
1457 {
1458 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1459 {
1460 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1461 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1462 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d.\n",
1463 bpt->owner->number);
1464 }
1465 else
1466 {
1467 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1468 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1469 bpt->owner->number);
1470 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1471 "Error accessing memory address ");
1472 fputs_filtered (paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address),
1473 tmp_error_stream);
1474 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1475 safe_strerror (val));
1476 }
1477
1478 }
1479 }
1480 else
1481 bpt->inserted = 1;
1482
1483 return val;
1484 }
1485
1486 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1487 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1488 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1489 && bpt->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1490 {
1491 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1492 bpt->length,
1493 bpt->watchpoint_type);
1494
1495 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
1496 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
1497 if (val == 1 && bpt->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
1498 {
1499 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1500
1501 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
1502 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
1503 of this one. */
1504 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1505 if (loc != bpt
1506 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
1507 && watchpoint_locations_match (bpt, loc))
1508 {
1509 bpt->duplicate = 1;
1510 bpt->inserted = 1;
1511 bpt->target_info = loc->target_info;
1512 bpt->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1513 val = 0;
1514 break;
1515 }
1516
1517 if (val == 1)
1518 {
1519 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1520 bpt->length,
1521 hw_access);
1522 if (val == 0)
1523 bpt->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1524 }
1525 }
1526
1527 bpt->inserted = (val == 0);
1528 }
1529
1530 else if (bpt->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1531 {
1532 struct gdb_exception e = catch_exception (uiout, insert_catchpoint,
1533 bpt->owner, RETURN_MASK_ERROR);
1534 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, "warning: inserting catchpoint %d: ",
1535 bpt->owner->number);
1536 if (e.reason < 0)
1537 bpt->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1538 else
1539 bpt->inserted = 1;
1540
1541 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1542 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1543 so just return success. */
1544 return 0;
1545 }
1546
1547 return 0;
1548 }
1549
1550 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1551 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1552 PSPACE anymore. */
1553
1554 void
1555 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1556 {
1557 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1558 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1559
1560 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
1561 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1562 {
1563 if (b->pspace == pspace)
1564 delete_breakpoint (b);
1565 }
1566
1567 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1568 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
1569 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1570 {
1571 struct bp_location *tmp;
1572
1573 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1574 {
1575 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1576 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1577 else
1578 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1579 if (tmp->next == loc)
1580 {
1581 tmp->next = loc->next;
1582 break;
1583 }
1584 }
1585 }
1586
1587 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1588 removed locations above. */
1589 update_global_location_list (0);
1590 }
1591
1592 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1593 Throws exception on any error.
1594 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1595 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
1596 void
1597 insert_breakpoints (void)
1598 {
1599 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1600
1601 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1602 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1603 update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1604
1605 update_global_location_list (1);
1606
1607 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1608 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
1609 now. */
1610 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1611 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1612 }
1613
1614 /* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1615 remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1616 Both return zero if successful,
1617 or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior. */
1618
1619 static void
1620 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1621 {
1622 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1623 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1624 int error = 0;
1625 int val = 0;
1626 int disabled_breaks = 0;
1627 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1628
1629 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1630 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1631
1632 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1633 there was an error. */
1634 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1635
1636 save_current_space_and_thread ();
1637
1638 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1639 {
1640 struct thread_info *tp;
1641 CORE_ADDR last_addr;
1642
1643 if (!should_be_inserted (b) || b->inserted)
1644 continue;
1645
1646 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if the
1647 thread no longer exists. */
1648 if (b->owner->thread != -1
1649 && !valid_thread_id (b->owner->thread))
1650 continue;
1651
1652 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
1653
1654 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1655 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
1656 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1657 insert breakpoints. */
1658 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1659 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1660 continue;
1661
1662 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1663 &disabled_breaks,
1664 &hw_breakpoint_error);
1665 if (val)
1666 error = val;
1667 }
1668
1669 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint,
1670 remove them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
1671 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1672 {
1673 int some_failed = 0;
1674 struct bp_location *loc;
1675
1676 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1677 continue;
1678
1679 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1680 continue;
1681
1682 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1683 continue;
1684
1685 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1686 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1687 {
1688 some_failed = 1;
1689 break;
1690 }
1691 if (some_failed)
1692 {
1693 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1694 if (loc->inserted)
1695 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1696
1697 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1698 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1699 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1700 bpt->number);
1701 error = -1;
1702 }
1703 }
1704
1705 if (error)
1706 {
1707 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1708 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
1709 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1710 {
1711 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1712 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
1713 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
1714 }
1715 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
1716 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
1717 }
1718
1719 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1720 }
1721
1722 int
1723 remove_breakpoints (void)
1724 {
1725 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1726 int val = 0;
1727
1728 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1729 {
1730 if (b->inserted)
1731 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1732 }
1733 return val;
1734 }
1735
1736 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
1737
1738 int
1739 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
1740 {
1741 struct bp_location *b, **b_tmp;
1742 int val;
1743 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1744
1745 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, b_tmp)
1746 {
1747 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1748 continue;
1749
1750 if (b->inserted)
1751 {
1752 val = remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1753 if (val != 0)
1754 return val;
1755 }
1756 }
1757 return 0;
1758 }
1759
1760 int
1761 remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
1762 {
1763 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1764 int val = 0;
1765
1766 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1767 {
1768 if (b->inserted && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
1769 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1770 }
1771 return val;
1772 }
1773
1774 int
1775 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
1776 {
1777 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1778 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1779 int val;
1780 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1781 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
1782 struct inferior *inf;
1783 struct thread_info *tp;
1784
1785 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
1786 if (tp == NULL)
1787 return 1;
1788
1789 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1790 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1791
1792 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
1793
1794 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1795
1796 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1797 {
1798 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1799 continue;
1800
1801 if (b->inserted)
1802 {
1803 b->inserted = 0;
1804 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1805 &dummy1, &dummy2);
1806 if (val != 0)
1807 {
1808 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1809 return val;
1810 }
1811 }
1812 }
1813 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1814 return 0;
1815 }
1816
1817 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
1818
1819 static struct breakpoint *
1820 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
1821 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
1822 {
1823 struct symtab_and_line sal;
1824 struct breakpoint *b;
1825
1826 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
1827
1828 sal.pc = address;
1829 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
1830 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
1831
1832 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
1833 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
1834 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
1835
1836 return b;
1837 }
1838
1839 static void
1840 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1841 {
1842 struct objfile *objfile;
1843
1844 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1845 {
1846 struct breakpoint *b;
1847 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1848
1849 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1850 if (m == NULL)
1851 continue;
1852
1853 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1854 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1855 bp_overlay_event);
1856 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1857
1858 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
1859 {
1860 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
1861 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
1862 }
1863 else
1864 {
1865 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1866 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
1867 }
1868 }
1869 update_global_location_list (1);
1870 }
1871
1872 static void
1873 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1874 {
1875 struct program_space *pspace;
1876 struct objfile *objfile;
1877 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1878
1879 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
1880
1881 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
1882 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1883 {
1884 struct breakpoint *b;
1885 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1886
1887 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (get_objfile_arch (objfile)))
1888 continue;
1889
1890 set_current_program_space (pspace);
1891
1892 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1893 if (m == NULL)
1894 continue;
1895
1896 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1897 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1898 bp_longjmp_master);
1899 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1900 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1901 }
1902 update_global_location_list (1);
1903
1904 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1905 }
1906
1907 void
1908 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
1909 {
1910 struct breakpoint *b;
1911 struct breakpoint *temp;
1912 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
1913
1914 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
1915 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
1916 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
1917 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
1918 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
1919 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
1920 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
1921 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
1922 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
1923 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
1924 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
1925
1926 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
1927 {
1928 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
1929 continue;
1930
1931 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1932 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
1933 {
1934 delete_breakpoint (b);
1935 continue;
1936 }
1937
1938 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1939 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
1940 {
1941 delete_breakpoint (b);
1942 continue;
1943 }
1944
1945 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
1946 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
1947 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
1948 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
1949 {
1950 delete_breakpoint (b);
1951 continue;
1952 }
1953
1954 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
1955 if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
1956 {
1957 delete_breakpoint (b);
1958 continue;
1959 }
1960
1961 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
1962 after an exec. */
1963 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume)
1964 {
1965 delete_breakpoint (b);
1966 continue;
1967 }
1968
1969 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
1970 {
1971 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
1972 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
1973 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
1974 a new method, and call this method from here. */
1975 continue;
1976 }
1977
1978 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
1979 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
1980 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
1981 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
1982 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
1983 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
1984
1985 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
1986 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
1987 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
1988 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
1989 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
1990 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
1991 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
1992
1993 In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
1994 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
1995 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
1996 let finish_command delete it.
1997
1998 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
1999 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
2000 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
2001 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
2002 solib breakpoints.) */
2003
2004 if (b->type == bp_finish)
2005 {
2006 continue;
2007 }
2008
2009 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
2010 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
2011 a.out. */
2012 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
2013 {
2014 delete_breakpoint (b);
2015 continue;
2016 }
2017 }
2018 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
2019 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
2020 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
2021 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
2022 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
2023 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
2024 }
2025
2026 int
2027 detach_breakpoints (int pid)
2028 {
2029 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
2030 int val = 0;
2031 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
2032 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
2033
2034 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
2035 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
2036
2037 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
2038 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
2039 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
2040 {
2041 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
2042 continue;
2043
2044 if (b->inserted)
2045 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (b, mark_inserted);
2046 }
2047 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2048 return val;
2049 }
2050
2051 /* Remove the breakpoint location B from the current address space.
2052 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2053 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2054 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2055 *not* look at b->pspace->aspace here. */
2056
2057 static int
2058 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2059 {
2060 int val;
2061 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2062
2063 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2064 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2065 return 0;
2066
2067 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2068 This should not ever happen. */
2069 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2070
2071 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2072 || b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2073 {
2074 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2075 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2076 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
2077
2078 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2079 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2080 || b->section == NULL
2081 || !(section_is_overlay (b->section)))
2082 {
2083 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
2084
2085 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2086 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2087 else
2088 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2089 }
2090 else
2091 {
2092 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2093 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2094 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2095 {
2096 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2097 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
2098 */
2099 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2100 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
2101 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2102 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2103 &b->overlay_target_info);
2104 else
2105 target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2106 &b->overlay_target_info);
2107 }
2108 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2109 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
2110 if (b->inserted)
2111 {
2112 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
2113 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2114 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
2115 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
2116 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2117 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2118 &b->target_info);
2119
2120 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2121 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2122 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
2123 else if (section_is_mapped (b->section))
2124 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2125 &b->target_info);
2126 else
2127 val = 0;
2128 }
2129 else
2130 {
2131 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
2132 val = 0;
2133 }
2134 }
2135
2136 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2137 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2138 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
2139 if (val && solib_name_from_address (b->pspace, b->address))
2140 val = 0;
2141
2142 if (val)
2143 return val;
2144 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2145 }
2146 else if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2147 {
2148 struct value *v;
2149 struct value *n;
2150
2151 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2152 val = target_remove_watchpoint (b->address, b->length,
2153 b->watchpoint_type);
2154
2155 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
2156 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (b->inserted))
2157 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2158 b->owner->number);
2159 }
2160 else if (b->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2161 && breakpoint_enabled (b->owner)
2162 && !b->duplicate)
2163 {
2164 gdb_assert (b->owner->ops != NULL && b->owner->ops->remove != NULL);
2165
2166 val = b->owner->ops->remove (b->owner);
2167 if (val)
2168 return val;
2169 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2170 }
2171
2172 return 0;
2173 }
2174
2175 static int
2176 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2177 {
2178 int ret;
2179 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2180
2181 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2182 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2183 return 0;
2184
2185 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2186 This should not ever happen. */
2187 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2188
2189 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2190
2191 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
2192
2193 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (b, is);
2194
2195 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2196 return ret;
2197 }
2198
2199 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
2200
2201 void
2202 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2203 {
2204 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2205
2206 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2207 if (bpt->pspace == current_program_space)
2208 bpt->inserted = 0;
2209 }
2210
2211 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2212 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2213
2214 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2215 between runs.
2216
2217 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2218 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2219 init_wait_for_inferior). */
2220
2221
2222
2223 void
2224 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2225 {
2226 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
2227 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2228 int ix;
2229 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2230
2231 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2232 nothing to do. */
2233 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2234 return;
2235
2236 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2237 {
2238 if (bpt->pspace == pspace
2239 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2240 bpt->inserted = 0;
2241 }
2242
2243 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2244 {
2245 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2246 continue;
2247
2248 switch (b->type)
2249 {
2250 case bp_call_dummy:
2251
2252 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2253 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
2254 rid of it. */
2255
2256 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2257
2258 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
2259
2260 case bp_shlib_event:
2261
2262 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
2263 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
2264 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
2265 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
2266 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
2267
2268 (gdb) file prog-linux
2269 (gdb) run # native linux target
2270 ...
2271 (gdb) kill
2272 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
2273 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
2274 */
2275
2276 delete_breakpoint (b);
2277 break;
2278
2279 case bp_watchpoint:
2280 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2281 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2282 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2283
2284 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
2285 if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2286 delete_breakpoint (b);
2287 else if (context == inf_starting)
2288 {
2289 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value
2290 in insert_breakpoints. */
2291 if (b->val)
2292 value_free (b->val);
2293 b->val = NULL;
2294 b->val_valid = 0;
2295 }
2296 break;
2297 default:
2298 break;
2299 }
2300 }
2301
2302 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
2303 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bpt); ++ix)
2304 free_bp_location (bpt);
2305 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2306 }
2307
2308 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2309 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2310 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2311 match, not program space. */
2312
2313 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2314 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2315 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2316 permanent breakpoint.
2317 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2318 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2319 - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2320 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2321 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
2322
2323 enum breakpoint_here
2324 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2325 {
2326 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2327 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2328
2329 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2330 {
2331 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2332 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2333 continue;
2334
2335 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2336 || bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2337 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2338 aspace, pc))
2339 {
2340 if (overlay_debugging
2341 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2342 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2343 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2344 else if (bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2345 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2346 else
2347 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2348 }
2349 }
2350
2351 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2352 }
2353
2354 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
2355
2356 int
2357 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2358 {
2359 struct bp_location *loc;
2360 int ix;
2361
2362 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2363 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2364 aspace, pc))
2365 return 1;
2366
2367 return 0;
2368 }
2369
2370 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2371 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array mechanism.
2372 This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which are
2373 inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
2374
2375 int
2376 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2377 {
2378 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2379
2380 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2381 {
2382 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2383 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2384 continue;
2385
2386 if (bpt->inserted
2387 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2388 aspace, pc))
2389 {
2390 if (overlay_debugging
2391 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2392 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2393 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2394 else
2395 return 1;
2396 }
2397 }
2398 return 0;
2399 }
2400
2401 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2402 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
2403
2404 int
2405 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2406 {
2407 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2408 return 1;
2409
2410 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2411 return 1;
2412
2413 return 0;
2414 }
2415
2416 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2417 inserted at PC. */
2418
2419 int
2420 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2421 {
2422 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2423 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2424
2425 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2426 {
2427 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2428 continue;
2429
2430 if (bpt->inserted
2431 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2432 aspace, pc))
2433 {
2434 if (overlay_debugging
2435 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2436 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2437 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2438 else
2439 return 1;
2440 }
2441 }
2442
2443 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
2444 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2445 return 1;
2446
2447 return 0;
2448 }
2449
2450 int
2451 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2452 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2453 {
2454 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2455
2456 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2457 {
2458 struct bp_location *loc;
2459
2460 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2461 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2462 continue;
2463
2464 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2465 continue;
2466
2467 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2468 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2469 {
2470 CORE_ADDR l, h;
2471
2472 /* Check for intersection. */
2473 l = max (loc->address, addr);
2474 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2475 if (l < h)
2476 return 1;
2477 }
2478 }
2479 return 0;
2480 }
2481
2482 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2483 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
2484
2485 int
2486 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2487 ptid_t ptid)
2488 {
2489 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2490 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
2491 int thread = -1;
2492 int task = 0;
2493
2494 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2495 {
2496 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2497 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2498 continue;
2499
2500 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2501 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2502 continue;
2503
2504 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2505 aspace, pc))
2506 continue;
2507
2508 if (bpt->owner->thread != -1)
2509 {
2510 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2511 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2512 it is now time to do so. */
2513 if (thread == -1)
2514 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2515 if (bpt->owner->thread != thread)
2516 continue;
2517 }
2518
2519 if (bpt->owner->task != 0)
2520 {
2521 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2522 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
2523 it is now time to do so. */
2524 if (task == 0)
2525 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2526 if (bpt->owner->task != task)
2527 continue;
2528 }
2529
2530 if (overlay_debugging
2531 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2532 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2533 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2534
2535 return 1;
2536 }
2537
2538 return 0;
2539 }
2540 \f
2541
2542 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
2543 in breakpoint.h. */
2544
2545 int
2546 ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2547 {
2548 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2549 }
2550
2551 void
2552 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
2553 {
2554 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2555 value_free (bs->old_val);
2556 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2557 xfree (bs);
2558 }
2559
2560 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
2561 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
2562
2563 void
2564 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
2565 {
2566 bpstat p;
2567 bpstat q;
2568
2569 if (bsp == 0)
2570 return;
2571 p = *bsp;
2572 while (p != NULL)
2573 {
2574 q = p->next;
2575 bpstat_free (p);
2576 p = q;
2577 }
2578 *bsp = NULL;
2579 }
2580
2581 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
2582 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
2583
2584 bpstat
2585 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
2586 {
2587 bpstat p = NULL;
2588 bpstat tmp;
2589 bpstat retval = NULL;
2590
2591 if (bs == NULL)
2592 return bs;
2593
2594 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2595 {
2596 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
2597 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
2598 if (bs->commands != NULL)
2599 tmp->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
2600 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2601 {
2602 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
2603 release_value (tmp->old_val);
2604 }
2605
2606 if (p == NULL)
2607 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
2608 retval = tmp;
2609 else
2610 p->next = tmp;
2611 p = tmp;
2612 }
2613 p->next = NULL;
2614 return retval;
2615 }
2616
2617 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint */
2618
2619 bpstat
2620 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
2621 {
2622 if (bsp == NULL)
2623 return NULL;
2624
2625 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2626 {
2627 if (bsp->breakpoint_at && bsp->breakpoint_at->owner == breakpoint)
2628 return bsp;
2629 }
2630 return NULL;
2631 }
2632
2633 /* Find a step_resume breakpoint associated with this bpstat.
2634 (If there are multiple step_resume bp's on the list, this function
2635 will arbitrarily pick one.)
2636
2637 It is an error to use this function if BPSTAT doesn't contain a
2638 step_resume breakpoint.
2639
2640 See wait_for_inferior's use of this function. */
2641 struct breakpoint *
2642 bpstat_find_step_resume_breakpoint (bpstat bsp)
2643 {
2644 int current_thread;
2645
2646 gdb_assert (bsp != NULL);
2647
2648 current_thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
2649
2650 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2651 {
2652 if ((bsp->breakpoint_at != NULL)
2653 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->type == bp_step_resume)
2654 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == current_thread
2655 || bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == -1))
2656 return bsp->breakpoint_at->owner;
2657 }
2658
2659 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("No step_resume breakpoint found."));
2660 }
2661
2662
2663 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are stopped
2664 at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the remaining
2665 breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be good for
2666 anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
2667 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
2668 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
2669 we set it.
2670 Return 1 otherwise. */
2671
2672 int
2673 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
2674 {
2675 struct breakpoint *b;
2676
2677 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
2678 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
2679
2680 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that
2681 correspond to a single breakpoint -- otherwise,
2682 this function might return the same number more
2683 than once and this will look ugly. */
2684 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at ? (*bsp)->breakpoint_at->owner : NULL;
2685 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
2686 if (b == NULL)
2687 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
2688
2689 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
2690 return 1;
2691 }
2692
2693 /* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed. */
2694
2695 void
2696 bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
2697 {
2698 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2699 {
2700 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2701 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2702 {
2703 value_free (bs->old_val);
2704 bs->old_val = NULL;
2705 }
2706 }
2707 }
2708
2709 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
2710
2711 static void
2712 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
2713 {
2714 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2715 {
2716 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
2717
2718 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
2719 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
2720 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
2721 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
2722 if (tp->in_infcall)
2723 return;
2724 }
2725
2726 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
2727 }
2728
2729 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint command */
2730 static void
2731 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
2732 {
2733 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
2734 }
2735
2736 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at this
2737 location. Any of these commands could cause the process to proceed
2738 beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by checking
2739 the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
2740
2741 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
2742 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
2743 bpstat of the current thread. */
2744
2745 static int
2746 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
2747 {
2748 bpstat bs;
2749 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2750 int again = 0;
2751
2752 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
2753 in bs->commands. */
2754 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
2755 return 0;
2756
2757 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
2758 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
2759
2760 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
2761 bs = *bsp;
2762
2763 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
2764 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2765 {
2766 struct command_line *cmd;
2767 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
2768
2769 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
2770
2771 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
2772 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
2773 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
2774 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
2775 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
2776 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
2777 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
2778 the tree when we're done. */
2779 cmd = bs->commands;
2780 bs->commands = 0;
2781 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_free_command_lines (&cmd);
2782
2783 while (cmd != NULL)
2784 {
2785 execute_control_command (cmd);
2786
2787 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2788 break;
2789 else
2790 cmd = cmd->next;
2791 }
2792
2793 /* We can free this command tree now. */
2794 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
2795
2796 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2797 {
2798 if (target_can_async_p ())
2799 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
2800 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
2801 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
2802 ;
2803 else
2804 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
2805 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
2806 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
2807 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
2808 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
2809 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
2810 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
2811 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
2812 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
2813 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
2814 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
2815 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
2816 with the new stop_bpstat. */
2817 again = 1;
2818 break;
2819 }
2820 }
2821 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2822 return again;
2823 }
2824
2825 void
2826 bpstat_do_actions (void)
2827 {
2828 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
2829 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
2830 && target_has_execution
2831 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
2832 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
2833 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
2834 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
2835 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
2836 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
2837 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->stop_bpstat))
2838 break;
2839 }
2840
2841 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
2842
2843 static void
2844 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
2845 {
2846 if (val == NULL)
2847 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
2848 else
2849 {
2850 struct value_print_options opts;
2851 get_user_print_options (&opts);
2852 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
2853 }
2854 }
2855
2856 /* This is the normal print function for a bpstat. In the future,
2857 much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
2858 by having it set different print_it values.
2859
2860 Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called. It loops
2861 through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
2862 print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
2863 print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
2864 bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
2865
2866 Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
2867 and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
2868 PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
2869 don't print anything else.
2870 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
2871 that something to be followed by a location.
2872 PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
2873 that something to be followed by a location.
2874 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
2875 analysis. */
2876
2877 static enum print_stop_action
2878 print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
2879 {
2880 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2881 struct breakpoint *b;
2882 const struct bp_location *bl;
2883 struct ui_stream *stb;
2884 int bp_temp = 0;
2885 enum print_stop_action result;
2886
2887 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
2888 which has since been deleted. */
2889 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
2890 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2891 bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
2892 b = bl->owner;
2893
2894 stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
2895 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
2896
2897 switch (b->type)
2898 {
2899 case bp_breakpoint:
2900 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
2901 bp_temp = bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del;
2902 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
2903 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
2904 bl->address,
2905 b->number, 1);
2906 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
2907 if (bp_temp)
2908 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
2909 else
2910 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
2911 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2912 {
2913 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
2914 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
2915 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
2916 }
2917 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
2918 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
2919 result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
2920 break;
2921
2922 case bp_shlib_event:
2923 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
2924 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
2925 to shlib event" message.) */
2926 printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
2927 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2928 break;
2929
2930 case bp_thread_event:
2931 /* Not sure how we will get here.
2932 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
2933 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2934 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2935 break;
2936
2937 case bp_overlay_event:
2938 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
2939 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2940 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2941 break;
2942
2943 case bp_longjmp_master:
2944 /* These should never be enabled. */
2945 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2946 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2947 break;
2948
2949 case bp_watchpoint:
2950 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2951 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2952 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2953 ui_out_field_string
2954 (uiout, "reason",
2955 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2956 mention (b);
2957 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2958 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2959 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2960 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2961 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2962 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2963 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2964 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2965 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
2966 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2967 break;
2968
2969 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2970 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2971 ui_out_field_string
2972 (uiout, "reason",
2973 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2974 mention (b);
2975 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2976 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2977 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2978 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
2979 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2980 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2981 break;
2982
2983 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2984 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2985 {
2986 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2987 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2988 ui_out_field_string
2989 (uiout, "reason",
2990 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2991 mention (b);
2992 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2993 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2994 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2995 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2996 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2997 }
2998 else
2999 {
3000 mention (b);
3001 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3002 ui_out_field_string
3003 (uiout, "reason",
3004 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3005 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3006 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3007 }
3008 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3009 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3010 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3011 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3012 break;
3013
3014 /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
3015 here. */
3016
3017 case bp_finish:
3018 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3019 ui_out_field_string
3020 (uiout, "reason",
3021 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
3022 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3023 break;
3024
3025 case bp_until:
3026 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3027 ui_out_field_string
3028 (uiout, "reason",
3029 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
3030 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3031 break;
3032
3033 case bp_none:
3034 case bp_longjmp:
3035 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3036 case bp_step_resume:
3037 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3038 case bp_call_dummy:
3039 case bp_tracepoint:
3040 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
3041 case bp_jit_event:
3042 default:
3043 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3044 break;
3045 }
3046
3047 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3048 return result;
3049 }
3050
3051 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
3052 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
3053 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
3054 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
3055 normal_stop(). */
3056
3057 static enum print_stop_action
3058 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
3059 {
3060 switch (bs->print_it)
3061 {
3062 case print_it_noop:
3063 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
3064 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3065 break;
3066
3067 case print_it_done:
3068 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3069 relevant messages. */
3070 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3071 break;
3072
3073 case print_it_normal:
3074 {
3075 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3076 struct breakpoint *b = bl ? bl->owner : NULL;
3077
3078 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3079 print_it_typical. */
3080 /* FIXME: how breakpoint can ever be NULL here? */
3081 if (b != NULL && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3082 return b->ops->print_it (b);
3083 else
3084 return print_it_typical (bs);
3085 }
3086 break;
3087
3088 default:
3089 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3090 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3091 break;
3092 }
3093 }
3094
3095 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
3096 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3097 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. This
3098 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3099 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
3100 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
3101 routine is one of:
3102
3103 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing
3104 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3105 code to print the location. An example is
3106 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3107 the location.
3108 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3109 to also print the location part of the message.
3110 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3111 don't require a location appended to the end.
3112 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3113 further info to be printed.*/
3114
3115 enum print_stop_action
3116 bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3117 {
3118 int val;
3119
3120 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3121 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3122 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3123 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
3124 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3125 {
3126 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3127 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3128 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3129 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3130 return val;
3131 }
3132
3133 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3134 with and nothing was printed. */
3135 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3136 }
3137
3138 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
3139 This is used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3140 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to char * to
3141 make it pass through catch_errors. */
3142
3143 static int
3144 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3145 {
3146 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3147 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3148 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3149 return i;
3150 }
3151
3152 /* Allocate a new bpstat and chain it to the current one. */
3153
3154 static bpstat
3155 bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *bl, bpstat cbs /* Current "bs" value */ )
3156 {
3157 bpstat bs;
3158
3159 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3160 cbs->next = bs;
3161 bs->breakpoint_at = bl;
3162 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
3163 bs->commands = NULL;
3164 bs->old_val = NULL;
3165 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3166 return bs;
3167 }
3168 \f
3169 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
3170 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
3171
3172 int
3173 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3174 {
3175 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3176 CORE_ADDR addr;
3177 struct breakpoint *b;
3178
3179 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3180 {
3181 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
3182 as not triggered. */
3183 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3184 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3185 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3186 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3187 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3188
3189 return 0;
3190 }
3191
3192 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3193 {
3194 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3195 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
3196 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3197 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3198 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3199 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3200 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3201
3202 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3203 }
3204
3205 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
3206 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3207 triggered. */
3208
3209 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3210 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3211 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3212 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3213 {
3214 struct bp_location *loc;
3215 struct value *v;
3216
3217 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3218 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3219 /* Exact match not required. Within range is
3220 sufficient. */
3221 if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3222 addr, loc->address,
3223 loc->length))
3224 {
3225 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3226 break;
3227 }
3228 }
3229
3230 return 1;
3231 }
3232
3233 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3234 because of check_errors). */
3235 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
3236 #define WP_DELETED 1
3237 /* The value has changed. */
3238 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3239 /* The value has not changed. */
3240 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3241
3242 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3243 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3244
3245 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value changed.
3246
3247 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
3248 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
3249
3250 static int
3251 watchpoint_check (void *p)
3252 {
3253 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3254 struct breakpoint *b;
3255 struct frame_info *fr;
3256 int within_current_scope;
3257
3258 b = bs->breakpoint_at->owner;
3259
3260 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3261 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3262 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
3263 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3264 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3265
3266 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3267 within_current_scope = 1;
3268 else
3269 {
3270 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3271 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3272 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3273
3274 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're still
3275 in the function but the stack frame has already been invalidated.
3276 Since we can't rely on the values of local variables after the
3277 stack has been destroyed, we are treating the watchpoint in that
3278 state as `not changed' without further checking. Don't mark
3279 watchpoints as changed if the current frame is in an epilogue -
3280 even if they are in some other frame, our view of the stack
3281 is likely to be wrong and frame_find_by_id could error out. */
3282 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3283 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3284
3285 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3286 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3287
3288 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3289 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
3290 if (within_current_scope)
3291 {
3292 struct symbol *function;
3293
3294 function = get_frame_function (fr);
3295 if (function == NULL
3296 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3297 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3298 within_current_scope = 0;
3299 }
3300
3301 if (within_current_scope)
3302 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3303 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
3304 the user. */
3305 select_frame (fr);
3306 }
3307
3308 if (within_current_scope)
3309 {
3310 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a
3311 *long* time before we return to the command level and
3312 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because
3313 we might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
3314
3315 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3316 struct value *new_val;
3317
3318 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3319
3320 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because the latter
3321 coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just the address of the
3322 array instead of its contents. This is not what we want. */
3323 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3324 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
3325 {
3326 if (new_val != NULL)
3327 {
3328 release_value (new_val);
3329 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3330 }
3331 bs->old_val = b->val;
3332 b->val = new_val;
3333 b->val_valid = 1;
3334 /* We will stop here */
3335 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3336 }
3337 else
3338 {
3339 /* Nothing changed, don't do anything. */
3340 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3341 /* We won't stop here */
3342 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3343 }
3344 }
3345 else
3346 {
3347 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3348 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3349 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3350 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3351 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3352 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3353 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3354 the first value assigned). */
3355 /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3356 in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3357 will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3358 information here. */
3359 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3360 ui_out_field_string
3361 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3362 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3363 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3364 ui_out_text (uiout, " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3365 which its expression is valid.\n");
3366
3367 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3368 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3369 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3370
3371 return WP_DELETED;
3372 }
3373 }
3374
3375 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3376 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we
3377 should stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
3378 static int
3379 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3380 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3381 {
3382 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3383
3384 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
3385 tracepoints. */
3386 if (tracepoint_type (b))
3387 return 0;
3388
3389 if (b->type != bp_watchpoint
3390 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
3391 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
3392 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint
3393 && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3394 && b->type != bp_catchpoint) /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3395 {
3396 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3397 aspace, bp_addr))
3398 return 0;
3399 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3400 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3401 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3402 return 0;
3403 }
3404
3405 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3406 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3407 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3408 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3409 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3410 (did not match the data address). */
3411
3412 if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3413 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3414 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3415 && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3416 return 0;
3417
3418 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3419 {
3420 if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3421 return 0;
3422 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3423 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3424 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3425 return 0;
3426 }
3427
3428 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3429 {
3430 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3431 if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3432 return 0;
3433 }
3434
3435 return 1;
3436 }
3437
3438 /* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3439 has actually changed, and we should stop. If not, set BS->stop
3440 to 0. */
3441 static void
3442 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3443 {
3444 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3445 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3446
3447 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint
3448 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3449 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
3450 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3451 {
3452 CORE_ADDR addr;
3453 struct value *v;
3454 int must_check_value = 0;
3455
3456 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3457 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3458 watched value. */
3459 must_check_value = 1;
3460 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3461 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3462 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3463 this watchpoint. */
3464 must_check_value = 1;
3465 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3466 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3467 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3468 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
3469 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3470 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
3471 must_check_value = 1;
3472
3473 if (must_check_value)
3474 {
3475 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3476 b->number);
3477 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3478 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3479 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3480 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3481 switch (e)
3482 {
3483 case WP_DELETED:
3484 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3485 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3486 /* Stop. */
3487 break;
3488 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3489 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3490 {
3491 /* There are two cases to consider here:
3492
3493 1. we're watching the triggered memory for reads.
3494 In that case, trust the target, and always report
3495 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
3496 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
3497 have changed since the last time it was read, and
3498 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
3499 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
3500 old value.
3501
3502 2. we're watching the triggered memory for both
3503 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
3504 happen:
3505
3506 2.1. this is a target that can't break on data
3507 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
3508 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
3509 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
3510
3511 2.2. otherwise, the target supports read
3512 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
3513 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
3514 watchpoint.
3515
3516 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
3517 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
3518 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
3519 changes. This still gives false positives when
3520 the program writes the same value to memory as
3521 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
3522 it for a read), but it's much better than
3523 nothing. */
3524
3525 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
3526
3527 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
3528 {
3529 struct breakpoint *other_b;
3530
3531 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
3532 if ((other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3533 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3534 && (other_b->watchpoint_triggered
3535 == watch_triggered_yes))
3536 {
3537 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
3538 break;
3539 }
3540 }
3541
3542 if (other_write_watchpoint
3543 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
3544 {
3545 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
3546 and the value changed since the last time we
3547 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
3548 Ignore it. */
3549 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3550 bs->stop = 0;
3551 }
3552 }
3553 break;
3554 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
3555 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3556 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3557 {
3558 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3559 the value hasn't changed. */
3560 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3561 bs->stop = 0;
3562 }
3563 /* Stop. */
3564 break;
3565 default:
3566 /* Can't happen. */
3567 case 0:
3568 /* Error from catch_errors. */
3569 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
3570 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3571 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3572 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3573 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3574 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3575 break;
3576 }
3577 }
3578 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
3579 {
3580 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
3581 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
3582 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
3583 anything for this watchpoint. */
3584 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3585 bs->stop = 0;
3586 }
3587 }
3588 }
3589
3590
3591 /* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
3592 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
3593 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
3594 static void
3595 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
3596 {
3597 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3598 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3599 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3600
3601 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
3602 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
3603 bs->stop = 0;
3604 else if (bs->stop)
3605 {
3606 int value_is_zero = 0;
3607
3608 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
3609 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
3610 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
3611 iteration. */
3612 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
3613 b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3614
3615 if (bl->cond && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
3616 {
3617 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
3618 be a long time before we return to the command level and
3619 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
3620 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
3621 function call. */
3622 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3623
3624 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
3625 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
3626 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
3627 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
3628 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
3629 call site. */
3630 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
3631 value_is_zero
3632 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, (bl->cond),
3633 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
3634 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3635 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint # */
3636 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3637 }
3638 if (bl->cond && value_is_zero)
3639 {
3640 bs->stop = 0;
3641 }
3642 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
3643 {
3644 bs->stop = 0;
3645 }
3646 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
3647 {
3648 b->ignore_count--;
3649 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
3650 bs->stop = 0;
3651 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't
3652 stop. */
3653 ++(b->hit_count);
3654 }
3655 }
3656 }
3657
3658
3659 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
3660 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
3661
3662 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
3663 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such that:
3664
3665 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
3666
3667 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
3668
3669 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
3670 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
3671 several reasons concurrently.)
3672
3673 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
3674 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
3675
3676 bpstat
3677 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
3678 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
3679 {
3680 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
3681 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3682 struct bp_location *loc;
3683 /* Root of the chain of bpstat's */
3684 struct bpstats root_bs[1];
3685 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
3686 bpstat bs = root_bs;
3687 int ix;
3688 int need_remove_insert;
3689
3690 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS iteration would break across
3691 update_global_location_list possibly executed by
3692 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions's inferior call. */
3693
3694 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3695 {
3696 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3697 continue;
3698
3699 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
3700 {
3701 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first location.
3702 The watchpoint_check function will work on entire expression,
3703 not the individual locations. For read watchopints, the
3704 watchpoints_triggered function have checked all locations
3705 already. */
3706 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
3707 break;
3708
3709 if (bl->shlib_disabled)
3710 continue;
3711
3712 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
3713 continue;
3714
3715 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address matches */
3716
3717 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, bs); /* Alloc a bpstat to explain stop */
3718
3719 /* Assume we stop. Should we find watchpoint that is not actually
3720 triggered, or if condition of breakpoint is false, we'll reset
3721 'stop' to 0. */
3722 bs->stop = 1;
3723 bs->print = 1;
3724
3725 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
3726 if (!bs->stop)
3727 continue;
3728
3729 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3730 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
3731 /* We do not stop for these. */
3732 bs->stop = 0;
3733 else
3734 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
3735
3736 if (bs->stop)
3737 {
3738 ++(b->hit_count);
3739
3740 /* We will stop here */
3741 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
3742 {
3743 if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3744 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3745 update_global_location_list (0);
3746 }
3747 if (b->silent)
3748 bs->print = 0;
3749 bs->commands = b->commands;
3750 if (bs->commands
3751 && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands->line) == 0
3752 || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q",
3753 bs->commands->line) == 0)))
3754 {
3755 bs->commands = bs->commands->next;
3756 bs->print = 0;
3757 }
3758 bs->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
3759 }
3760
3761 /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or dont print. */
3762 if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
3763 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3764 }
3765 }
3766
3767 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
3768 {
3769 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
3770 aspace, bp_addr))
3771 {
3772 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, bs);
3773 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
3774 bs->stop = 0;
3775 bs->print = 0;
3776 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3777 }
3778 }
3779
3780 bs->next = NULL; /* Terminate the chain */
3781
3782 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
3783 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
3784 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
3785 done later. */
3786 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3787 if (bs->stop)
3788 break;
3789
3790 need_remove_insert = 0;
3791 if (bs == NULL)
3792 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3793 if (!bs->stop
3794 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
3795 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner))
3796 {
3797 update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3798 /* Updating watchpoints invalidates bs->breakpoint_at.
3799 Prevent further code from trying to use it. */
3800 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
3801 need_remove_insert = 1;
3802 }
3803
3804 if (need_remove_insert)
3805 update_global_location_list (1);
3806
3807 return root_bs->next;
3808 }
3809 \f
3810 /* Tell what to do about this bpstat. */
3811 struct bpstat_what
3812 bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
3813 {
3814 /* Classify each bpstat as one of the following. */
3815 enum class
3816 {
3817 /* This bpstat element has no effect on the main_action. */
3818 no_effect = 0,
3819
3820 /* There was a watchpoint, stop but don't print. */
3821 wp_silent,
3822
3823 /* There was a watchpoint, stop and print. */
3824 wp_noisy,
3825
3826 /* There was a breakpoint but we're not stopping. */
3827 bp_nostop,
3828
3829 /* There was a breakpoint, stop but don't print. */
3830 bp_silent,
3831
3832 /* There was a breakpoint, stop and print. */
3833 bp_noisy,
3834
3835 /* We hit the longjmp breakpoint. */
3836 long_jump,
3837
3838 /* We hit the longjmp_resume breakpoint. */
3839 long_resume,
3840
3841 /* We hit the step_resume breakpoint. */
3842 step_resume,
3843
3844 /* We hit the shared library event breakpoint. */
3845 shlib_event,
3846
3847 /* We hit the jit event breakpoint. */
3848 jit_event,
3849
3850 /* This is just used to count how many enums there are. */
3851 class_last
3852 };
3853
3854 /* Here is the table which drives this routine. So that we can
3855 format it pretty, we define some abbreviations for the
3856 enum bpstat_what codes. */
3857 #define kc BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
3858 #define ss BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
3859 #define sn BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3860 #define sgl BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
3861 #define slr BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME
3862 #define clr BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME
3863 #define sr BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME
3864 #define shl BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_SHLIBS
3865 #define jit BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_JIT
3866
3867 /* "Can't happen." Might want to print an error message.
3868 abort() is not out of the question, but chances are GDB is just
3869 a bit confused, not unusable. */
3870 #define err BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3871
3872 /* Given an old action and a class, come up with a new action. */
3873 /* One interesting property of this table is that wp_silent is the same
3874 as bp_silent and wp_noisy is the same as bp_noisy. That is because
3875 after stopping, the check for whether to step over a breakpoint
3876 (BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE type stuff) is handled in proceed() without
3877 reference to how we stopped. We retain separate wp_silent and
3878 bp_silent codes in case we want to change that someday.
3879
3880 Another possibly interesting property of this table is that
3881 there's a partial ordering, priority-like, of the actions. Once
3882 you've decided that some action is appropriate, you'll never go
3883 back and decide something of a lower priority is better. The
3884 ordering is:
3885
3886 kc < jit clr sgl shl slr sn sr ss
3887 sgl < jit shl slr sn sr ss
3888 slr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3889 clr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3890 ss < jit shl sn sr
3891 sn < jit shl sr
3892 jit < shl sr
3893 shl < sr
3894 sr <
3895
3896 What I think this means is that we don't need a damned table
3897 here. If you just put the rows and columns in the right order,
3898 it'd look awfully regular. We could simply walk the bpstat list
3899 and choose the highest priority action we find, with a little
3900 logic to handle the 'err' cases. */
3901
3902 /* step_resume entries: a step resume breakpoint overrides another
3903 breakpoint of signal handling (see comment in wait_for_inferior
3904 at where we set the step_resume breakpoint). */
3905
3906 static const enum bpstat_what_main_action
3907 table[(int) class_last][(int) BPSTAT_WHAT_LAST] =
3908 {
3909 /* old action */
3910 /* kc ss sn sgl slr clr sr shl jit */
3911 /* no_effect */ {kc, ss, sn, sgl, slr, clr, sr, shl, jit},
3912 /* wp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
3913 /* wp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
3914 /* bp_nostop */ {sgl, ss, sn, sgl, slr, slr, sr, shl, jit},
3915 /* bp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
3916 /* bp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
3917 /* long_jump */ {slr, ss, sn, slr, slr, err, sr, shl, jit},
3918 /* long_resume */ {clr, ss, sn, err, err, err, sr, shl, jit},
3919 /* step_resume */ {sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr },
3920 /* shlib */ {shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, sr, shl, shl},
3921 /* jit_event */ {jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, sr, jit, jit}
3922 };
3923
3924 #undef kc
3925 #undef ss
3926 #undef sn
3927 #undef sgl
3928 #undef slr
3929 #undef clr
3930 #undef err
3931 #undef sr
3932 #undef ts
3933 #undef shl
3934 #undef jit
3935 enum bpstat_what_main_action current_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
3936 struct bpstat_what retval;
3937
3938 retval.call_dummy = 0;
3939 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3940 {
3941 enum class bs_class = no_effect;
3942 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
3943 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary breakpoint
3944 which has since been deleted. */
3945 continue;
3946 if (bs->breakpoint_at->owner == NULL)
3947 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3948 else
3949 switch (bs->breakpoint_at->owner->type)
3950 {
3951 case bp_none:
3952 continue;
3953
3954 case bp_breakpoint:
3955 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
3956 case bp_until:
3957 case bp_finish:
3958 if (bs->stop)
3959 {
3960 if (bs->print)
3961 bs_class = bp_noisy;
3962 else
3963 bs_class = bp_silent;
3964 }
3965 else
3966 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3967 break;
3968 case bp_watchpoint:
3969 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3970 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3971 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3972 if (bs->stop)
3973 {
3974 if (bs->print)
3975 bs_class = wp_noisy;
3976 else
3977 bs_class = wp_silent;
3978 }
3979 else
3980 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3981 This requires no further action. */
3982 bs_class = no_effect;
3983 break;
3984 case bp_longjmp:
3985 bs_class = long_jump;
3986 break;
3987 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3988 bs_class = long_resume;
3989 break;
3990 case bp_step_resume:
3991 if (bs->stop)
3992 {
3993 bs_class = step_resume;
3994 }
3995 else
3996 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
3997 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3998 break;
3999 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4000 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4001 break;
4002 case bp_shlib_event:
4003 bs_class = shlib_event;
4004 break;
4005 case bp_jit_event:
4006 bs_class = jit_event;
4007 break;
4008 case bp_thread_event:
4009 case bp_overlay_event:
4010 case bp_longjmp_master:
4011 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4012 break;
4013 case bp_catchpoint:
4014 if (bs->stop)
4015 {
4016 if (bs->print)
4017 bs_class = bp_noisy;
4018 else
4019 bs_class = bp_silent;
4020 }
4021 else
4022 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4023 This requires no further action. */
4024 bs_class = no_effect;
4025 break;
4026 case bp_call_dummy:
4027 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
4028 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
4029 bs_class = bp_silent;
4030 retval.call_dummy = 1;
4031 break;
4032 case bp_tracepoint:
4033 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4034 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
4035 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
4036 out already. */
4037 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4038 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
4039 break;
4040 }
4041 current_action = table[(int) bs_class][(int) current_action];
4042 }
4043 retval.main_action = current_action;
4044 return retval;
4045 }
4046
4047 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
4048 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
4049 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
4050
4051 int
4052 bpstat_should_step (void)
4053 {
4054 struct breakpoint *b;
4055 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4056 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
4057 return 1;
4058 return 0;
4059 }
4060
4061 int
4062 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
4063 {
4064 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4065 if (bs->stop)
4066 return 1;
4067
4068 return 0;
4069 }
4070
4071 \f
4072
4073 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
4074
4075 static void print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4076 struct bp_location *loc,
4077 char *wrap_indent,
4078 struct ui_stream *stb)
4079 {
4080 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
4081
4082 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
4083 loc = NULL;
4084
4085 if (loc != NULL)
4086 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
4087
4088 if (b->source_file && loc)
4089 {
4090 struct symbol *sym
4091 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
4092 if (sym)
4093 {
4094 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
4095 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
4096 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
4097 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent);
4098 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
4099 }
4100 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
4101 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
4102
4103 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4104 {
4105 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
4106 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
4107
4108 if (fullname)
4109 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
4110 }
4111
4112 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
4113 }
4114 else if (loc)
4115 {
4116 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb->stream,
4117 demangle, "");
4118 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
4119 }
4120 else
4121 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
4122
4123 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4124 }
4125
4126 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
4127 static void
4128 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4129 struct bp_location *loc,
4130 int loc_number,
4131 struct bp_location **last_loc,
4132 int print_address_bits,
4133 int allflag)
4134 {
4135 struct command_line *l;
4136 struct symbol *sym;
4137 struct ep_type_description
4138 {
4139 enum bptype type;
4140 char *description;
4141 };
4142 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
4143 {
4144 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4145 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4146 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4147 {bp_until, "until"},
4148 {bp_finish, "finish"},
4149 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4150 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4151 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4152 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4153 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4154 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4155 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4156 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4157 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4158 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4159 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4160 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4161 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4162 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4163 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4164 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
4165 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4166 };
4167
4168 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4169 char wrap_indent[80];
4170 struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4171 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4172 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4173
4174 int header_of_multiple = 0;
4175 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4176 struct value_print_options opts;
4177
4178 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4179
4180 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4181 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning
4182 treatment of breakpoints with single disabled
4183 location. */
4184 if (loc == NULL
4185 && (b->loc != NULL
4186 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4187 header_of_multiple = 1;
4188 if (loc == NULL)
4189 loc = b->loc;
4190
4191 annotate_record ();
4192 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4193
4194 /* 1 */
4195 annotate_field (0);
4196 if (part_of_multiple)
4197 {
4198 char *formatted;
4199 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4200 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4201 xfree (formatted);
4202 }
4203 else
4204 {
4205 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4206 }
4207
4208 /* 2 */
4209 annotate_field (1);
4210 if (part_of_multiple)
4211 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4212 else
4213 {
4214 if (((int) b->type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4215 || ((int) b->type != bptypes[(int) b->type].type))
4216 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4217 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4218 (int) b->type);
4219 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptypes[(int) b->type].description);
4220 }
4221
4222 /* 3 */
4223 annotate_field (2);
4224 if (part_of_multiple)
4225 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4226 else
4227 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4228
4229
4230 /* 4 */
4231 annotate_field (3);
4232 if (part_of_multiple)
4233 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4234 else
4235 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4236 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4237 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4238
4239
4240 /* 5 and 6 */
4241 strcpy (wrap_indent, " ");
4242 if (opts.addressprint)
4243 {
4244 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4245 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4246 else
4247 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4248 }
4249
4250 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4251 {
4252 /* Although the print_one can possibly print
4253 all locations, calling it here is not likely
4254 to get any nice result. So, make sure there's
4255 just one location. */
4256 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4257 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4258 }
4259 else
4260 switch (b->type)
4261 {
4262 case bp_none:
4263 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4264 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4265 break;
4266
4267 case bp_watchpoint:
4268 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4269 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4270 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4271 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4272 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4273 is relatively readable). */
4274 if (opts.addressprint)
4275 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4276 annotate_field (5);
4277 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4278 break;
4279
4280 case bp_breakpoint:
4281 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4282 case bp_until:
4283 case bp_finish:
4284 case bp_longjmp:
4285 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4286 case bp_step_resume:
4287 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4288 case bp_call_dummy:
4289 case bp_shlib_event:
4290 case bp_thread_event:
4291 case bp_overlay_event:
4292 case bp_longjmp_master:
4293 case bp_tracepoint:
4294 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4295 case bp_jit_event:
4296 if (opts.addressprint)
4297 {
4298 annotate_field (4);
4299 if (header_of_multiple)
4300 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4301 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4302 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4303 else
4304 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4305 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4306 }
4307 annotate_field (5);
4308 if (!header_of_multiple)
4309 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc, wrap_indent, stb);
4310 if (b->loc)
4311 *last_loc = b->loc;
4312 break;
4313 }
4314
4315
4316 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4317 are several. */
4318 if (loc != NULL
4319 && !header_of_multiple
4320 && (allflag
4321 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4322 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4323 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4324 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4325 {
4326 struct inferior *inf;
4327 int first = 1;
4328
4329 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4330 {
4331 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4332 {
4333 if (first)
4334 {
4335 first = 0;
4336 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4337 }
4338 else
4339 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4340 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4341 }
4342 }
4343 }
4344
4345 if (!part_of_multiple)
4346 {
4347 if (b->thread != -1)
4348 {
4349 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4350 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4351 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4352 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4353 }
4354 else if (b->task != 0)
4355 {
4356 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4357 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4358 }
4359 }
4360
4361 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4362
4363 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4364 {
4365 annotate_field (6);
4366 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4367 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4368 the frame ID. */
4369 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4370 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4371 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4372 }
4373
4374 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4375 {
4376 /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4377 because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4378 that we do not want to expose to the user. */
4379 annotate_field (7);
4380 if (tracepoint_type (b))
4381 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4382 else
4383 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4384 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4385 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4386 }
4387
4388 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4389 {
4390 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4391 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4392 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4393 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4394 }
4395
4396 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4397 {
4398 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4399 if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4400 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4401 else
4402 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4403 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4404 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4405 if (b->hit_count == 1)
4406 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4407 else
4408 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4409 }
4410
4411 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is
4412 mi. FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4413 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4414 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4415 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4416
4417 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4418 {
4419 annotate_field (8);
4420 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4421 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4422 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4423 }
4424
4425 l = b->commands;
4426 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4427 {
4428 struct cleanup *script_chain;
4429
4430 annotate_field (9);
4431 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4432 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4433 do_cleanups (script_chain);
4434 }
4435
4436 if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4437 {
4438 annotate_field (10);
4439 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4440 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4441 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4442 }
4443
4444 if (!part_of_multiple && b->step_count)
4445 {
4446 annotate_field (11);
4447 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstep count ");
4448 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "step", b->step_count);
4449 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4450 }
4451
4452 if (!part_of_multiple && b->actions)
4453 {
4454 struct action_line *action;
4455 annotate_field (12);
4456 for (action = b->actions; action; action = action->next)
4457 {
4458 ui_out_text (uiout, " A\t");
4459 ui_out_text (uiout, action->action);
4460 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4461 }
4462 }
4463
4464 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4465 {
4466 if (b->addr_string)
4467 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4468 else if (b->exp_string)
4469 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4470 }
4471
4472 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4473 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4474 }
4475
4476 static void
4477 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4478 struct bp_location **last_loc, int print_address_bits,
4479 int allflag)
4480 {
4481 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc,
4482 print_address_bits, allflag);
4483
4484 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
4485 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
4486 locations, if any. */
4487 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
4488 {
4489 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is
4490 disabled, we print it as if it had
4491 several locations, since otherwise it's hard to
4492 represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
4493 situation.
4494 Note that while hardware watchpoints have
4495 several locations internally, that's no a property
4496 exposed to user. */
4497 if (b->loc
4498 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
4499 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
4500 && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4501 {
4502 struct bp_location *loc;
4503 int n = 1;
4504 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
4505 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
4506 print_address_bits, allflag);
4507 }
4508 }
4509 }
4510
4511 static int
4512 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
4513 {
4514 int print_address_bits = 0;
4515 struct bp_location *loc;
4516
4517 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4518 {
4519 int addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
4520 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4521 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4522 }
4523
4524 return print_address_bits;
4525 }
4526
4527 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
4528 {
4529 int bnum;
4530 };
4531
4532 static int
4533 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
4534 {
4535 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
4536 struct breakpoint *b;
4537 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
4538 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4539 {
4540 if (args->bnum == b->number)
4541 {
4542 int print_address_bits = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4543 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, print_address_bits, 0);
4544 return GDB_RC_OK;
4545 }
4546 }
4547 return GDB_RC_NONE;
4548 }
4549
4550 enum gdb_rc
4551 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum, char **error_message)
4552 {
4553 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
4554 args.bnum = bnum;
4555 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
4556 an error. */
4557 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
4558 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
4559 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
4560 else
4561 return GDB_RC_OK;
4562 }
4563
4564 /* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
4565 catchpoints, et.al.). */
4566
4567 static int
4568 user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
4569 {
4570 return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
4571 || b->type == bp_catchpoint
4572 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4573 || tracepoint_type (b)
4574 || b->type == bp_watchpoint
4575 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
4576 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
4577 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint);
4578 }
4579
4580 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
4581 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user settable breakpoints.
4582 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non- user settable breakpoints. */
4583
4584 static void
4585 breakpoint_1 (int bnum, int allflag)
4586 {
4587 struct breakpoint *b;
4588 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
4589 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
4590 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
4591 struct value_print_options opts;
4592 int print_address_bits = 0;
4593
4594 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4595
4596 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the
4597 size required for address fields. */
4598 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
4599 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4600 if (bnum == -1
4601 || bnum == b->number)
4602 {
4603 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4604 {
4605 int addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4606 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4607 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4608
4609 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
4610 }
4611 }
4612
4613 if (opts.addressprint)
4614 bkpttbl_chain
4615 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4616 "BreakpointTable");
4617 else
4618 bkpttbl_chain
4619 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4620 "BreakpointTable");
4621
4622 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4623 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
4624 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4625 annotate_field (0);
4626 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
4627 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4628 annotate_field (1);
4629 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 14, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
4630 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4631 annotate_field (2);
4632 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
4633 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4634 annotate_field (3);
4635 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
4636 if (opts.addressprint)
4637 {
4638 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4639 annotate_field (4);
4640 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4641 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4642 else
4643 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4644 }
4645 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4646 annotate_field (5);
4647 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
4648 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
4649 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4650 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
4651
4652 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4653 if (bnum == -1
4654 || bnum == b->number)
4655 {
4656 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
4657 allflag is set. */
4658 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4659 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, print_address_bits, allflag);
4660 }
4661
4662 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
4663
4664 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
4665 {
4666 if (bnum == -1)
4667 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
4668 else
4669 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoint or watchpoint number %d.\n",
4670 bnum);
4671 }
4672 else
4673 {
4674 if (last_loc && !server_command)
4675 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
4676 }
4677
4678 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
4679 there have been breakpoints? */
4680 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
4681 }
4682
4683 static void
4684 breakpoints_info (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4685 {
4686 int bnum = -1;
4687
4688 if (bnum_exp)
4689 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4690
4691 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 0);
4692 }
4693
4694 static void
4695 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4696 {
4697 int bnum = -1;
4698
4699 if (bnum_exp)
4700 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4701
4702 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 1);
4703 }
4704
4705 static int
4706 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
4707 struct program_space *pspace,
4708 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
4709 {
4710 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
4711 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
4712 {
4713 if (bl->pspace == pspace
4714 && bl->address == pc
4715 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
4716 return 1;
4717 }
4718 return 0;
4719 }
4720
4721 /* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC. This
4722 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
4723 address spaces. */
4724
4725 static void
4726 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4727 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
4728 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
4729 {
4730 int others = 0;
4731 struct breakpoint *b;
4732
4733 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4734 others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
4735 if (others > 0)
4736 {
4737 if (others == 1)
4738 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
4739 else /* if (others == ???) */
4740 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
4741 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4742 if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
4743 {
4744 others--;
4745 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
4746 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
4747 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
4748 else if (b->thread != -1)
4749 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
4750 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
4751 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
4752 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
4753 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
4754 ? " (disabled)"
4755 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
4756 ? " (permanent)"
4757 : ""),
4758 (others > 1) ? ","
4759 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
4760 }
4761 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
4762 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
4763 printf_filtered (".\n");
4764 }
4765 }
4766 \f
4767 /* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
4768 for the `break' command with no arguments. */
4769
4770 void
4771 set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
4772 CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
4773 int line)
4774 {
4775 default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
4776 default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
4777 default_breakpoint_address = addr;
4778 default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
4779 default_breakpoint_line = line;
4780 }
4781
4782 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
4783 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
4784 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
4785 (or use it for any other purpose either).
4786
4787 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will always
4788 have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of
4789 these types to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint at address zero:
4790
4791 bp_watchpoint
4792 bp_catchpoint
4793
4794 */
4795
4796 static int
4797 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4798 {
4799 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
4800
4801 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
4802 }
4803
4804 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
4805 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
4806
4807 static int
4808 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4809 {
4810 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
4811 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
4812 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
4813 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
4814 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
4815 become hw_access locations later. */
4816 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
4817 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
4818 && loc1->address == loc2->address
4819 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
4820 }
4821
4822 /* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
4823 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
4824 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
4825 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
4826
4827 static int
4828 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
4829 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
4830 {
4831 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4832 || aspace1 == aspace2)
4833 && addr1 == addr2);
4834 }
4835
4836 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
4837 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
4838 represent the same location. */
4839
4840 static int
4841 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4842 {
4843 int hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
4844 int hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
4845
4846 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
4847 return 0;
4848 else if (hw_point1)
4849 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
4850 else
4851 return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
4852 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
4853 }
4854
4855 static void
4856 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
4857 int bnum, int have_bnum)
4858 {
4859 char astr1[40];
4860 char astr2[40];
4861
4862 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
4863 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
4864 if (have_bnum)
4865 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
4866 bnum, astr1, astr2);
4867 else
4868 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
4869 }
4870
4871 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural constraints
4872 on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address. Note: Very
4873 few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most targets,
4874 this function is simply the identity function. */
4875
4876 static CORE_ADDR
4877 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4878 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
4879 {
4880 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
4881 {
4882 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
4883 return bpaddr;
4884 }
4885 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
4886 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
4887 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
4888 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
4889 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
4890 {
4891 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
4892 have their addresses modified. */
4893 return bpaddr;
4894 }
4895 else
4896 {
4897 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
4898
4899 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
4900 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
4901 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
4902
4903 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
4904 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
4905 is required. */
4906 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
4907 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
4908
4909 return adjusted_bpaddr;
4910 }
4911 }
4912
4913 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
4914
4915 static struct bp_location *
4916 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4917 {
4918 struct bp_location *loc, *loc_p;
4919
4920 loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
4921 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
4922
4923 loc->owner = bpt;
4924 loc->cond = NULL;
4925 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
4926 loc->enabled = 1;
4927
4928 switch (bpt->type)
4929 {
4930 case bp_breakpoint:
4931 case bp_until:
4932 case bp_finish:
4933 case bp_longjmp:
4934 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4935 case bp_step_resume:
4936 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4937 case bp_call_dummy:
4938 case bp_shlib_event:
4939 case bp_thread_event:
4940 case bp_overlay_event:
4941 case bp_jit_event:
4942 case bp_longjmp_master:
4943 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
4944 break;
4945 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4946 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
4947 break;
4948 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4949 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4950 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4951 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
4952 break;
4953 case bp_watchpoint:
4954 case bp_catchpoint:
4955 case bp_tracepoint:
4956 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4957 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
4958 break;
4959 default:
4960 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
4961 }
4962
4963 return loc;
4964 }
4965
4966 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
4967 {
4968 if (loc->cond)
4969 xfree (loc->cond);
4970
4971 if (loc->function_name)
4972 xfree (loc->function_name);
4973
4974 xfree (loc);
4975 }
4976
4977 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
4978 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
4979 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
4980
4981 static struct breakpoint *
4982 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4983 enum bptype bptype)
4984 {
4985 struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
4986
4987 b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
4988 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
4989
4990 b->type = bptype;
4991 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
4992 b->language = current_language->la_language;
4993 b->input_radix = input_radix;
4994 b->thread = -1;
4995 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
4996 b->next = 0;
4997 b->silent = 0;
4998 b->ignore_count = 0;
4999 b->commands = NULL;
5000 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
5001 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5002 b->exec_pathname = NULL;
5003 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
5004 b->ops = NULL;
5005 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
5006
5007 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain
5008 so that a list of breakpoints will come out in order
5009 of increasing numbers. */
5010
5011 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
5012 if (b1 == 0)
5013 breakpoint_chain = b;
5014 else
5015 {
5016 while (b1->next)
5017 b1 = b1->next;
5018 b1->next = b;
5019 }
5020 return b;
5021 }
5022
5023 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
5024 static void
5025 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
5026 {
5027 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
5028 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
5029 || tracepoint_type (loc->owner))
5030 {
5031 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
5032 NULL, NULL);
5033 if (loc->function_name)
5034 loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
5035 }
5036 }
5037
5038 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
5039 static struct gdbarch *
5040 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
5041 {
5042 if (sal.section)
5043 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
5044 if (sal.symtab)
5045 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
5046
5047 return NULL;
5048 }
5049
5050 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
5051 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
5052 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
5053 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
5054 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
5055 is also returned as the value of this function.
5056
5057 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
5058 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
5059 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
5060 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
5061 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
5062 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
5063 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
5064
5065 struct breakpoint *
5066 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5067 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
5068 {
5069 struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, bptype);
5070 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
5071 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
5072
5073 loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
5074 if (!loc_gdbarch)
5075 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
5076
5077 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
5078 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
5079
5080 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
5081 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
5082 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
5083 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
5084 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
5085 location that's only been partially initialized. */
5086 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, sal.pc, b->type);
5087
5088 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
5089 b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
5090 b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
5091 b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
5092 b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
5093
5094 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
5095 breakpoint resetting. */
5096 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
5097
5098 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
5099 b->source_file = NULL;
5100 else
5101 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
5102 b->loc->section = sal.section;
5103 b->line_number = sal.line;
5104
5105 set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
5106
5107 breakpoints_changed ();
5108
5109 return b;
5110 }
5111
5112
5113 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
5114 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
5115 void
5116 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
5117 {
5118 struct bp_location *bl;
5119 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
5120
5121 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the code.
5122 Mark all locations as inserted. For now, make_breakpoint_permanent
5123 is called in just one place, so it's hard to say if it's reasonable
5124 to have permanent breakpoint with multiple locations or not,
5125 but it's easy to implmement. */
5126 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5127 bl->inserted = 1;
5128 }
5129
5130 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
5131 if we do a longjmp() in THREAD. When we hit that breakpoint, call
5132 set_longjmp_resume_breakpoint() to figure out where we are going. */
5133
5134 void
5135 set_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5136 {
5137 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5138
5139 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
5140 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
5141 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
5142 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
5143 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5144 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5145 && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
5146 {
5147 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5148 clone->type = bp_longjmp;
5149 clone->thread = thread;
5150 }
5151 }
5152
5153 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
5154 void
5155 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5156 {
5157 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5158
5159 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5160 if (b->type == bp_longjmp)
5161 {
5162 if (b->thread == thread)
5163 delete_breakpoint (b);
5164 }
5165 }
5166
5167 void
5168 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5169 {
5170 struct breakpoint *b;
5171
5172 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5173 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5174 {
5175 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5176 update_global_location_list (1);
5177 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5178 }
5179 }
5180
5181 void
5182 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5183 {
5184 struct breakpoint *b;
5185
5186 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5187 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5188 {
5189 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5190 update_global_location_list (0);
5191 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5192 }
5193 }
5194
5195 struct breakpoint *
5196 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5197 {
5198 struct breakpoint *b;
5199
5200 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5201
5202 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5203 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
5204 b->addr_string
5205 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5206
5207 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5208
5209 return b;
5210 }
5211
5212 void
5213 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5214 {
5215 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5216
5217 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5218 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5219 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5220 delete_breakpoint (b);
5221 }
5222
5223 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5224 {
5225 char **arg_p;
5226 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5227 char ***addr_string_p;
5228 int *not_found_ptr;
5229 };
5230
5231 struct lang_and_radix
5232 {
5233 enum language lang;
5234 int radix;
5235 };
5236
5237 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
5238
5239 struct breakpoint *
5240 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5241 {
5242 struct breakpoint *b;
5243
5244 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5245 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5246 return b;
5247 }
5248
5249 void
5250 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5251 {
5252 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5253
5254 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5255 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5256 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5257 delete_breakpoint (b);
5258 }
5259
5260 struct breakpoint *
5261 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5262 {
5263 struct breakpoint *b;
5264
5265 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5266 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5267 return b;
5268 }
5269
5270 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
5271 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5272
5273 void
5274 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
5275 {
5276 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5277
5278 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5279 {
5280 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5281 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled
5282 for those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
5283 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to insert
5284 all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here, we'll try
5285 to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
5286 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
5287 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5288 || (tracepoint_type (b)))
5289 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
5290 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5291 #ifdef PC_SOLIB
5292 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
5293 #else
5294 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
5295 #endif
5296 )
5297 {
5298 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5299 }
5300 }
5301 }
5302
5303 /* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library. Only
5304 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5305
5306 static void
5307 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
5308 {
5309 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5310 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
5311
5312 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
5313 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
5314 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
5315 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
5316 if (exec_bfd != NULL
5317 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
5318 return;
5319
5320 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5321 {
5322 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5323 if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5324 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
5325 && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
5326 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5327 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5328 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
5329 {
5330 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5331 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
5332 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
5333 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
5334 loc->inserted = 0;
5335 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
5336 {
5337 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5338 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
5339 solib->so_name);
5340 }
5341 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
5342 }
5343 }
5344 }
5345
5346 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
5347
5348 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5349
5350 static void
5351 insert_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5352 {
5353 target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5354 }
5355
5356 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5357
5358 static int
5359 remove_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5360 {
5361 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5362 }
5363
5364 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5365 catchpoints. */
5366
5367 static int
5368 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5369 {
5370 return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5371 }
5372
5373 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5374
5375 static enum print_stop_action
5376 print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5377 {
5378 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5379 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
5380 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5381 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5382 }
5383
5384 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5385
5386 static void
5387 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5388 {
5389 struct value_print_options opts;
5390
5391 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5392
5393 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5394 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5395 is relatively readable). */
5396 if (opts.addressprint)
5397 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5398 annotate_field (5);
5399 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
5400 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5401 {
5402 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5403 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5404 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5405 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5406 }
5407 }
5408
5409 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5410 catchpoints. */
5411
5412 static void
5413 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5414 {
5415 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
5416 }
5417
5418 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
5419
5420 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
5421 {
5422 insert_catch_fork,
5423 remove_catch_fork,
5424 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
5425 print_it_catch_fork,
5426 print_one_catch_fork,
5427 print_mention_catch_fork
5428 };
5429
5430 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5431
5432 static void
5433 insert_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5434 {
5435 target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5436 }
5437
5438 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5439
5440 static int
5441 remove_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5442 {
5443 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5444 }
5445
5446 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5447 catchpoints. */
5448
5449 static int
5450 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5451 {
5452 return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5453 }
5454
5455 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5456
5457 static enum print_stop_action
5458 print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5459 {
5460 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5461 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
5462 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5463 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5464 }
5465
5466 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5467
5468 static void
5469 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5470 {
5471 struct value_print_options opts;
5472
5473 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5474 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5475 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5476 is relatively readable). */
5477 if (opts.addressprint)
5478 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5479 annotate_field (5);
5480 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
5481 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5482 {
5483 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5484 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5485 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5486 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5487 }
5488 }
5489
5490 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5491 catchpoints. */
5492
5493 static void
5494 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5495 {
5496 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
5497 }
5498
5499 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
5500
5501 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
5502 {
5503 insert_catch_vfork,
5504 remove_catch_vfork,
5505 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
5506 print_it_catch_vfork,
5507 print_one_catch_vfork,
5508 print_mention_catch_vfork
5509 };
5510
5511 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5512 catchpoints. */
5513
5514 static void
5515 insert_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5516 {
5517 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5518
5519 ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
5520 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5521 ++inf->any_syscall_count;
5522 else
5523 {
5524 int i, iter;
5525 for (i = 0;
5526 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5527 i++)
5528 {
5529 int elem;
5530 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5531 {
5532 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
5533 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
5534 uintptr_t vec_addr;
5535 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
5536 vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
5537 vec_addr_offset;
5538 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
5539 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
5540 }
5541 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5542 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
5543 }
5544 }
5545
5546 target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5547 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5548 inf->any_syscall_count,
5549 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5550 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5551 }
5552
5553 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5554 catchpoints. */
5555
5556 static int
5557 remove_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5558 {
5559 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5560
5561 --inf->total_syscalls_count;
5562 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5563 --inf->any_syscall_count;
5564 else
5565 {
5566 int i, iter;
5567 for (i = 0;
5568 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5569 i++)
5570 {
5571 int elem;
5572 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5573 /* Shouldn't happen. */
5574 continue;
5575 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5576 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
5577 }
5578 }
5579
5580 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5581 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5582 inf->any_syscall_count,
5583 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5584 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5585 }
5586
5587 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5588 catchpoints. */
5589
5590 static int
5591 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5592 {
5593 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this breakpoint.
5594 If we are, then we must guarantee that the called syscall is the same
5595 syscall we are catching. */
5596 int syscall_number = 0;
5597
5598 if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
5599 return 0;
5600
5601 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
5602 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5603 {
5604 int i, iter;
5605 for (i = 0;
5606 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5607 i++)
5608 if (syscall_number == iter)
5609 break;
5610 /* Not the same. */
5611 if (!iter)
5612 return 0;
5613 }
5614
5615 return 1;
5616 }
5617
5618 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5619 catchpoints. */
5620
5621 static enum print_stop_action
5622 print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5623 {
5624 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
5625 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
5626 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
5627 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
5628 ptid_t ptid;
5629 struct target_waitstatus last;
5630 struct syscall s;
5631 struct cleanup *old_chain;
5632 char *syscall_id;
5633
5634 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
5635
5636 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
5637
5638 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5639
5640 if (s.name == NULL)
5641 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
5642 else
5643 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
5644
5645 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
5646
5647 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
5648 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
5649 b->number, syscall_id);
5650 else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
5651 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
5652 b->number, syscall_id);
5653
5654 do_cleanups (old_chain);
5655
5656 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5657 }
5658
5659 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5660 catchpoints. */
5661
5662 static void
5663 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
5664 struct bp_location **last_loc)
5665 {
5666 struct value_print_options opts;
5667
5668 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5669 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5670 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5671 is relatively readable). */
5672 if (opts.addressprint)
5673 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5674 annotate_field (5);
5675
5676 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
5677 && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5678 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
5679 else
5680 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
5681
5682 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5683 {
5684 int i, iter;
5685 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
5686 for (i = 0;
5687 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5688 i++)
5689 {
5690 char *x = text;
5691 struct syscall s;
5692 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5693
5694 if (s.name != NULL)
5695 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
5696 else
5697 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
5698
5699 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
5700 because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
5701 on every call. */
5702 xfree (x);
5703 }
5704 /* Remove the last comma. */
5705 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
5706 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
5707 }
5708 else
5709 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
5710 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5711 }
5712
5713 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5714 catchpoints. */
5715
5716 static void
5717 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5718 {
5719 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5720 {
5721 int i, iter;
5722
5723 if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5724 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
5725 else
5726 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
5727
5728 for (i = 0;
5729 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5730 i++)
5731 {
5732 struct syscall s;
5733 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5734
5735 if (s.name)
5736 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
5737 else
5738 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
5739 }
5740 printf_filtered (")");
5741 }
5742 else
5743 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
5744 b->number);
5745 }
5746
5747 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
5748
5749 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
5750 {
5751 insert_catch_syscall,
5752 remove_catch_syscall,
5753 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
5754 print_it_catch_syscall,
5755 print_one_catch_syscall,
5756 print_mention_catch_syscall
5757 };
5758
5759 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
5760
5761 static int
5762 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
5763 {
5764 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
5765 }
5766
5767 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
5768 but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
5769 This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
5770 struct breakpoint before calling mention.
5771
5772 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5773 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5774 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5775 to the catchpoint. */
5776
5777 static struct breakpoint *
5778 create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5779 char *cond_string,
5780 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5781 {
5782 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5783 struct breakpoint *b;
5784
5785 init_sal (&sal);
5786 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
5787
5788 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
5789 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
5790 b->number = breakpoint_count;
5791
5792 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
5793 b->thread = -1;
5794 b->addr_string = NULL;
5795 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5796 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
5797 b->ops = ops;
5798
5799 return b;
5800 }
5801
5802 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
5803
5804 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5805 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5806 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5807 to the catchpoint. */
5808
5809 static struct breakpoint *
5810 create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5811 char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5812 {
5813 struct breakpoint *b =
5814 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5815
5816 mention (b);
5817 update_global_location_list (1);
5818
5819 return b;
5820 }
5821
5822 static void
5823 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5824 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
5825 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5826 {
5827 struct breakpoint *b
5828 = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5829
5830 /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
5831 area. */
5832 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5833 }
5834
5835 /* Exec catchpoints. */
5836
5837 static void
5838 insert_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5839 {
5840 target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5841 }
5842
5843 static int
5844 remove_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5845 {
5846 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5847 }
5848
5849 static int
5850 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5851 {
5852 return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
5853 }
5854
5855 static enum print_stop_action
5856 print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5857 {
5858 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5859 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
5860 b->exec_pathname);
5861 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5862 }
5863
5864 static void
5865 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5866 {
5867 struct value_print_options opts;
5868
5869 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5870
5871 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5872 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5873 is relatively readable). */
5874 if (opts.addressprint)
5875 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5876 annotate_field (5);
5877 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
5878 if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
5879 {
5880 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
5881 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
5882 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5883 }
5884 }
5885
5886 static void
5887 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5888 {
5889 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
5890 }
5891
5892 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
5893 {
5894 insert_catch_exec,
5895 remove_catch_exec,
5896 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
5897 print_it_catch_exec,
5898 print_one_catch_exec,
5899 print_mention_catch_exec
5900 };
5901
5902 static void
5903 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
5904 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5905 {
5906 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
5907 struct breakpoint *b =
5908 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
5909
5910 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
5911
5912 /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
5913 location list. */
5914 mention (b);
5915 update_global_location_list (1);
5916 }
5917
5918 static int
5919 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
5920 {
5921 struct breakpoint *b;
5922 int i = 0;
5923
5924 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5925 {
5926 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5927 i++;
5928 }
5929
5930 return i;
5931 }
5932
5933 static int
5934 hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
5935 {
5936 struct breakpoint *b;
5937 int i = 0;
5938
5939 *other_type_used = 0;
5940 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5941 {
5942 if (breakpoint_enabled (b))
5943 {
5944 if (b->type == type)
5945 i++;
5946 else if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5947 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
5948 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5949 *other_type_used = 1;
5950 }
5951 }
5952 return i;
5953 }
5954
5955 void
5956 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
5957 {
5958 struct breakpoint *b;
5959
5960 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5961 {
5962 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5963 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5964 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5965 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5966 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5967 {
5968 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
5969 update_global_location_list (0);
5970 }
5971 }
5972 }
5973
5974 void
5975 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
5976 {
5977 struct breakpoint *b;
5978
5979 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5980 {
5981 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5982 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5983 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5984 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5985 && (b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled))
5986 {
5987 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5988 update_global_location_list (1);
5989 }
5990 }
5991 }
5992
5993 void
5994 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
5995 {
5996 struct breakpoint *b;
5997 int found = 0;
5998
5999 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6000 {
6001 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6002 continue;
6003
6004 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6005 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6006 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6007 {
6008 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6009 found = 1;
6010 }
6011 }
6012
6013 if (found)
6014 update_global_location_list (0);
6015
6016 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
6017 }
6018
6019 void
6020 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
6021 {
6022 struct breakpoint *b;
6023 int found = 0;
6024
6025 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
6026
6027 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6028 {
6029 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6030 continue;
6031
6032 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6033 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6034 && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
6035 {
6036 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6037 found = 1;
6038 }
6039 }
6040
6041 if (found)
6042 breakpoint_re_set ();
6043 }
6044
6045
6046 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
6047 at address specified by SAL.
6048 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
6049
6050 struct breakpoint *
6051 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
6052 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
6053 {
6054 struct breakpoint *b;
6055
6056 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
6057 one. */
6058 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
6059
6060 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6061 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6062 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6063 b->frame_id = frame_id;
6064
6065 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we
6066 want momentary breakpoints to be active in only a
6067 single thread of control. */
6068 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
6069 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
6070
6071 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
6072
6073 return b;
6074 }
6075
6076 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
6077 ORIG is NULL. */
6078
6079 struct breakpoint *
6080 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
6081 {
6082 struct breakpoint *copy;
6083
6084 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
6085 if (orig == NULL)
6086 return NULL;
6087
6088 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
6089 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
6090 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
6091
6092 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
6093 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
6094 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
6095 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
6096 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
6097
6098 if (orig->source_file == NULL)
6099 copy->source_file = NULL;
6100 else
6101 copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
6102
6103 copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
6104 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
6105 copy->thread = orig->thread;
6106 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
6107
6108 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6109 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6110 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
6111
6112 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
6113 return copy;
6114 }
6115
6116 struct breakpoint *
6117 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
6118 enum bptype type)
6119 {
6120 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6121
6122 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
6123 sal.pc = pc;
6124 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
6125 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6126
6127 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
6128 }
6129 \f
6130
6131 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
6132
6133 static void
6134 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
6135 {
6136 int say_where = 0;
6137 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
6138 struct value_print_options opts;
6139
6140 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6141
6142 /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
6143 hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation. It should
6144 be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
6145 random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook. */
6146 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
6147
6148 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
6149 b->ops->print_mention (b);
6150 else
6151 switch (b->type)
6152 {
6153 case bp_none:
6154 printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "), b->number);
6155 break;
6156 case bp_watchpoint:
6157 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6158 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6159 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6160 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6161 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6162 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6163 break;
6164 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6165 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6166 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6167 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6168 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6169 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6170 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6171 break;
6172 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6173 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6174 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6175 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6176 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6177 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6178 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6179 break;
6180 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6181 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6182 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6183 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6184 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6185 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6186 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6187 break;
6188 case bp_breakpoint:
6189 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6190 {
6191 say_where = 0;
6192 break;
6193 }
6194 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
6195 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
6196 else
6197 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
6198 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6199 say_where = 1;
6200 break;
6201 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6202 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6203 {
6204 say_where = 0;
6205 break;
6206 }
6207 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
6208 say_where = 1;
6209 break;
6210 case bp_tracepoint:
6211 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6212 {
6213 say_where = 0;
6214 break;
6215 }
6216 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
6217 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6218 say_where = 1;
6219 break;
6220 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6221 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6222 {
6223 say_where = 0;
6224 break;
6225 }
6226 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
6227 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6228 say_where = 1;
6229 break;
6230
6231 case bp_until:
6232 case bp_finish:
6233 case bp_longjmp:
6234 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6235 case bp_step_resume:
6236 case bp_call_dummy:
6237 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6238 case bp_shlib_event:
6239 case bp_thread_event:
6240 case bp_overlay_event:
6241 case bp_jit_event:
6242 case bp_longjmp_master:
6243 break;
6244 }
6245
6246 if (say_where)
6247 {
6248 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
6249 single string. */
6250 if (b->loc == NULL)
6251 {
6252 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
6253 }
6254 else
6255 {
6256 if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
6257 {
6258 printf_filtered (" at ");
6259 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
6260 gdb_stdout);
6261 }
6262 if (b->source_file)
6263 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
6264 b->source_file, b->line_number);
6265
6266 if (b->loc->next)
6267 {
6268 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
6269 int n = 0;
6270 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6271 ++n;
6272 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
6273 }
6274
6275 }
6276 }
6277 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6278 return;
6279 printf_filtered ("\n");
6280 }
6281 \f
6282
6283 static struct bp_location *
6284 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6285 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6286 {
6287 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
6288
6289 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
6290 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
6291 ;
6292 *tmp = loc;
6293 loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
6294 if (!loc->gdbarch)
6295 loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
6296 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
6297 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
6298 loc->requested_address, b->type);
6299 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
6300 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
6301 loc->section = sal->section;
6302
6303 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
6304 return loc;
6305 }
6306 \f
6307
6308 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
6309 return 0 otherwise. */
6310
6311 static int
6312 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
6313 {
6314 int len;
6315 CORE_ADDR addr;
6316 const gdb_byte *brk;
6317 gdb_byte *target_mem;
6318 struct cleanup *cleanup;
6319 int retval = 0;
6320
6321 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
6322
6323 addr = loc->address;
6324 brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
6325
6326 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
6327 if (brk == NULL)
6328 return 0;
6329
6330 target_mem = alloca (len);
6331
6332 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
6333 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
6334 breakpoints they are permanent. */
6335 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6336
6337 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
6338 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
6339
6340 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
6341 && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
6342 retval = 1;
6343
6344 do_cleanups (cleanup);
6345
6346 return retval;
6347 }
6348
6349
6350
6351 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
6352 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
6353 as condition expression. */
6354
6355 static void
6356 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6357 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
6358 char *cond_string,
6359 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6360 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6361 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, int enabled)
6362 {
6363 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
6364 int i;
6365
6366 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6367 {
6368 int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
6369 int target_resources_ok =
6370 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
6371 i + 1, 0);
6372 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
6373 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
6374 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
6375 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
6376 }
6377
6378 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
6379
6380 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6381 {
6382 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
6383 struct bp_location *loc;
6384
6385 if (from_tty)
6386 {
6387 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
6388 if (!loc_gdbarch)
6389 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
6390
6391 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
6392 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
6393 }
6394
6395 if (i == 0)
6396 {
6397 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6398 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6399 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6400 b->thread = thread;
6401 b->task = task;
6402
6403 b->cond_string = cond_string;
6404 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6405 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6406 b->disposition = disposition;
6407
6408 b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
6409
6410 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6411 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6412 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6413 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6414
6415 loc = b->loc;
6416 }
6417 else
6418 {
6419 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
6420 }
6421
6422 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
6423 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
6424
6425 if (b->cond_string)
6426 {
6427 char *arg = b->cond_string;
6428 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
6429 if (*arg)
6430 error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
6431 }
6432 }
6433
6434 if (addr_string)
6435 b->addr_string = addr_string;
6436 else
6437 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
6438 me. */
6439 b->addr_string
6440 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
6441
6442 b->ops = ops;
6443 mention (b);
6444 }
6445
6446 /* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
6447 elements to fill the void space. */
6448 static void
6449 remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
6450 {
6451 int i = index_to_remove+1;
6452 int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
6453
6454 for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
6455 sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
6456
6457 --(sal->nelts);
6458 }
6459
6460 /* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
6461 and line as SAL, in all program spaces. Users debugging with IDEs,
6462 will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
6463 about program spaces. This is done only if SAL does not have
6464 explicit PC and has line and file information. If we got just a
6465 single expanded sal, return the original.
6466
6467 Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
6468 which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL. This
6469 makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
6470 instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
6471 the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'. */
6472
6473 static struct symtabs_and_lines
6474 expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
6475 {
6476 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
6477 CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
6478 char *original_function = NULL;
6479 int found;
6480 int i;
6481 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6482
6483 /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
6484 If we have no line number, we can't expand. */
6485 if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
6486 {
6487 expanded.nelts = 1;
6488 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6489 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6490 return expanded;
6491 }
6492
6493 sal.pc = 0;
6494
6495 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6496
6497 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
6498
6499 find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
6500
6501 /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces. */
6502 expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
6503
6504 if (expanded.nelts == 1)
6505 {
6506 /* We had one sal, we got one sal. Return that sal, adjusting it
6507 past the function prologue if necessary. */
6508 xfree (expanded.sals);
6509 expanded.nelts = 1;
6510 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6511 sal.pc = original_pc;
6512 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6513 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
6514 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6515 return expanded;
6516 }
6517
6518 if (!sal.explicit_line)
6519 {
6520 CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
6521 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6522 {
6523 CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
6524 char *this_function;
6525
6526 /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
6527 read memory. */
6528 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
6529
6530 if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
6531 &func_addr, &func_end))
6532 {
6533 if (this_function
6534 && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
6535 {
6536 remove_sal (&expanded, i);
6537 --i;
6538 }
6539 else if (func_addr == pc)
6540 {
6541 /* We're at beginning of a function, and should
6542 skip prologue. */
6543 struct symbol *sym = find_pc_function (pc);
6544 if (sym)
6545 expanded.sals[i] = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6546 else
6547 {
6548 /* Since find_pc_partial_function returned true,
6549 we should really always find the section here. */
6550 struct obj_section *section = find_pc_section (pc);
6551 if (section)
6552 {
6553 struct gdbarch *gdbarch
6554 = get_objfile_arch (section->objfile);
6555 expanded.sals[i].pc
6556 = gdbarch_skip_prologue (gdbarch, pc);
6557 }
6558 }
6559 }
6560 }
6561 }
6562 }
6563 else
6564 {
6565 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6566 {
6567 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a
6568 line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6569 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
6570 }
6571 }
6572
6573 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6574
6575 if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
6576 {
6577 /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero
6578 expanded sals then something is really wrong.
6579 Fix that by returnign the original sal. */
6580 xfree (expanded.sals);
6581 expanded.nelts = 1;
6582 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6583 sal.pc = original_pc;
6584 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6585 return expanded;
6586 }
6587
6588 if (original_pc)
6589 {
6590 found = 0;
6591 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6592 if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
6593 {
6594 found = 1;
6595 break;
6596 }
6597 gdb_assert (found);
6598 }
6599
6600 return expanded;
6601 }
6602
6603 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
6604 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
6605 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
6606 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
6607 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
6608 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
6609 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
6610 we take just a single condition string.
6611
6612 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
6613 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
6614 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
6615 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
6616 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
6617
6618 static void
6619 create_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6620 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
6621 char *cond_string,
6622 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6623 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6624 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
6625 int enabled)
6626 {
6627 int i;
6628 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6629 {
6630 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
6631 expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
6632
6633 create_breakpoint (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
6634 cond_string, type, disposition,
6635 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6636 }
6637 }
6638
6639 /* Parse ARG which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
6640 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
6641 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
6642 address strings. ARG points to the end of the SAL. */
6643
6644 static void
6645 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
6646 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6647 char ***addr_string,
6648 int *not_found_ptr)
6649 {
6650 char *addr_start = *address;
6651 *addr_string = NULL;
6652 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
6653 breakpoint. */
6654 if ((*address) == NULL
6655 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
6656 {
6657 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
6658 {
6659 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6660 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
6661 sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
6662 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6663 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
6664 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
6665 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
6666 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
6667 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
6668
6669 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" where PC is
6670 the default_breakpoint_address. So make sure to set
6671 sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to expand the list of
6672 sals to include all other instances with the same symtab and line.
6673 */
6674 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6675
6676 sals->sals[0] = sal;
6677 sals->nelts = 1;
6678 }
6679 else
6680 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
6681 }
6682 else
6683 {
6684 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
6685 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). This
6686 should produce the results we want almost all of the time while
6687 leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
6688 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
6689 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
6690
6691 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
6692
6693 if (default_breakpoint_valid
6694 && (!cursal.symtab
6695 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
6696 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
6697 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
6698 default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
6699 not_found_ptr);
6700 else
6701 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
6702 addr_string, not_found_ptr);
6703 }
6704 /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
6705 if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
6706 *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
6707 if (addr_start != (*address))
6708 {
6709 int i;
6710 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6711 {
6712 /* Add the string if not present. */
6713 if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
6714 (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start, (*address) - addr_start);
6715 }
6716 }
6717 }
6718
6719
6720 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
6721 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
6722
6723 static void
6724 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6725 char *address)
6726 {
6727 int i;
6728 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6729 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
6730 }
6731
6732 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
6733 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
6734 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
6735 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
6736 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
6737 it, etc. */
6738
6739 static void
6740 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6741 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
6742 {
6743 int i, rslt;
6744 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
6745 char *msg;
6746 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6747
6748 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6749 {
6750 sal = &sals->sals[i];
6751
6752 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (gdbarch, sal->pc,
6753 NULL, &msg);
6754 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
6755
6756 if (!rslt)
6757 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
6758 paddress (gdbarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
6759
6760 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6761 }
6762 }
6763
6764 static void
6765 do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
6766 {
6767 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
6768
6769 parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
6770 args->not_found_ptr);
6771 }
6772
6773 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
6774 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
6775 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
6776 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
6777 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
6778 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
6779 static void
6780 find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
6781 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
6782 {
6783 *cond_string = NULL;
6784 *thread = -1;
6785 while (tok && *tok)
6786 {
6787 char *end_tok;
6788 int toklen;
6789 char *cond_start = NULL;
6790 char *cond_end = NULL;
6791 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
6792 tok++;
6793
6794 end_tok = tok;
6795
6796 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
6797 end_tok++;
6798
6799 toklen = end_tok - tok;
6800
6801 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
6802 {
6803 struct expression *expr;
6804
6805 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
6806 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
6807 xfree (expr);
6808 cond_end = tok;
6809 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
6810 cond_end - cond_start);
6811 }
6812 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
6813 {
6814 char *tmptok;
6815
6816 tok = end_tok + 1;
6817 tmptok = tok;
6818 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6819 if (tok == tmptok)
6820 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
6821 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
6822 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
6823 }
6824 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
6825 {
6826 char *tmptok;
6827
6828 tok = end_tok + 1;
6829 tmptok = tok;
6830 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6831 if (tok == tmptok)
6832 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
6833 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
6834 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
6835 }
6836 else
6837 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
6838 }
6839 }
6840
6841 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between CLI and MI
6842 functions for setting a breakpoint. This function has two major
6843 modes of operations, selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD
6844 parameter. If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
6845 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise, ARG is just the
6846 location of breakpoint, with condition and thread specified by the
6847 COND_STRING and THREAD parameters. Returns true if any breakpoint
6848 was created; false otherwise. */
6849
6850 static int
6851 break_command_really (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6852 char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
6853 int parse_condition_and_thread,
6854 int tempflag, int hardwareflag, int traceflag,
6855 int ignore_count,
6856 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
6857 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
6858 int from_tty,
6859 int enabled)
6860 {
6861 struct gdb_exception e;
6862 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
6863 struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
6864 char *copy_arg;
6865 char *err_msg;
6866 char *addr_start = arg;
6867 char **addr_string;
6868 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6869 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
6870 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
6871 int i;
6872 int pending = 0;
6873 int not_found = 0;
6874 enum bptype type_wanted;
6875 int task = 0;
6876
6877 sals.sals = NULL;
6878 sals.nelts = 0;
6879 addr_string = NULL;
6880
6881 parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
6882 parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
6883 parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
6884 parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
6885
6886 e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
6887 &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
6888
6889 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
6890 switch (e.reason)
6891 {
6892 case RETURN_QUIT:
6893 throw_exception (e);
6894 case RETURN_ERROR:
6895 switch (e.error)
6896 {
6897 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
6898
6899 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
6900 error. */
6901
6902 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
6903 throw_exception (e);
6904
6905 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
6906
6907 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
6908 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
6909 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
6910 && !nquery ("Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? "))
6911 return 0;
6912
6913 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
6914 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
6915 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
6916 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
6917 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
6918 addr_string = &copy_arg;
6919 sals.nelts = 1;
6920 sals.sals = &pending_sal;
6921 pending_sal.pc = 0;
6922 pending = 1;
6923 break;
6924 default:
6925 throw_exception (e);
6926 }
6927 default:
6928 if (!sals.nelts)
6929 return 0;
6930 }
6931
6932 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
6933 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6934
6935 if (!pending)
6936 {
6937 /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed. */
6938 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
6939
6940 /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
6941 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
6942 }
6943
6944 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
6945 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
6946 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
6947 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
6948 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6949
6950 /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup. These go on
6951 the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails. */
6952 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
6953 {
6954 if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
6955 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
6956 }
6957
6958 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
6959 are ok for the target. */
6960 if (!pending)
6961 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals, addr_start);
6962
6963 type_wanted = (traceflag
6964 ? (hardwareflag ? bp_fast_tracepoint : bp_tracepoint)
6965 : (hardwareflag ? bp_hardware_breakpoint : bp_breakpoint));
6966
6967 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
6968 if (type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
6969 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &sals);
6970
6971 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
6972 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
6973 breakpoint. */
6974 if (!pending)
6975 {
6976 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
6977 {
6978 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
6979 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
6980 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
6981 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
6982 cond_string = NULL;
6983 thread = -1;
6984 find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
6985 &thread, &task);
6986 if (cond_string)
6987 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6988 }
6989 else
6990 {
6991 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
6992 if (cond_string)
6993 {
6994 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
6995 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6996 }
6997 }
6998 create_breakpoints (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string, type_wanted,
6999 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
7000 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
7001 }
7002 else
7003 {
7004 struct symtab_and_line sal = {0};
7005 struct breakpoint *b;
7006
7007 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
7008
7009 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
7010 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7011 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7012 b->thread = -1;
7013 b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
7014 b->cond_string = NULL;
7015 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
7016 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7017 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
7018 b->ops = ops;
7019 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
7020 b->pspace = current_program_space;
7021
7022 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
7023 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
7024 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
7025 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
7026
7027 mention (b);
7028 }
7029
7030 if (sals.nelts > 1)
7031 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\n"
7032 "Use the \"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
7033 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
7034 breakpoint. */
7035 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
7036 /* But cleanup everything else. */
7037 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7038
7039 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
7040 update_global_location_list (1);
7041
7042 return 1;
7043 }
7044
7045 /* Set a breakpoint.
7046 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
7047 condition, and thread.
7048 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
7049 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
7050 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
7051
7052 static void
7053 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
7054 {
7055 int hardwareflag = flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG;
7056 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
7057
7058 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
7059 arg,
7060 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
7061 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
7062 0 /* Ignore count */,
7063 pending_break_support,
7064 NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
7065 from_tty,
7066 1 /* enabled */);
7067 }
7068
7069
7070 void
7071 set_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7072 char *address, char *condition,
7073 int hardwareflag, int tempflag,
7074 int thread, int ignore_count,
7075 int pending, int enabled)
7076 {
7077 break_command_really (gdbarch,
7078 address, condition, thread,
7079 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
7080 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
7081 ignore_count,
7082 pending
7083 ? AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE : AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE,
7084 NULL, 0, enabled);
7085 }
7086
7087 /* Adjust SAL to the first instruction past the function prologue.
7088 The end of the prologue is determined using the line table from
7089 the debugging information. explicit_pc and explicit_line are
7090 not modified.
7091
7092 If SAL is already past the prologue, then do nothing. */
7093
7094 static void
7095 skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7096 {
7097 struct symbol *sym;
7098 struct symtab_and_line start_sal;
7099 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7100
7101 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7102
7103 sym = find_pc_function (sal->pc);
7104 if (sym != NULL)
7105 {
7106 start_sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
7107 if (sal->pc < start_sal.pc)
7108 {
7109 start_sal.explicit_line = sal->explicit_line;
7110 start_sal.explicit_pc = sal->explicit_pc;
7111 *sal = start_sal;
7112 }
7113 }
7114
7115 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7116 }
7117
7118 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
7119
7120 void
7121 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7122 {
7123 CORE_ADDR pc;
7124
7125 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7126 {
7127 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
7128 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
7129 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
7130 sal->pc = pc;
7131
7132 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using
7133 a line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
7134 if (sal->explicit_line)
7135 {
7136 /* Preserve the original line number. */
7137 int saved_line = sal->line;
7138 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
7139 sal->line = saved_line;
7140 }
7141 }
7142
7143 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7144 {
7145 struct blockvector *bv;
7146 struct block *b;
7147 struct symbol *sym;
7148
7149 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
7150 if (bv != NULL)
7151 {
7152 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
7153 if (sym != NULL)
7154 {
7155 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
7156 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
7157 }
7158 else
7159 {
7160 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll just
7161 have to look harder. This case can be executed if we have
7162 line numbers but no functions (as can happen in assembly
7163 source). */
7164
7165 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
7166 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7167
7168 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
7169
7170 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
7171 if (msym)
7172 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
7173
7174 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7175 }
7176 }
7177 }
7178 }
7179
7180 void
7181 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7182 {
7183 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7184 }
7185
7186 void
7187 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7188 {
7189 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
7190 }
7191
7192 static void
7193 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7194 {
7195 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
7196 }
7197
7198 static void
7199 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7200 {
7201 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
7202 }
7203
7204 static void
7205 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7206 {
7207 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
7208 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
7209 stop at <line>\n"));
7210 }
7211
7212 static void
7213 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7214 {
7215 int badInput = 0;
7216
7217 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
7218 badInput = 1;
7219 else if (*arg != '*')
7220 {
7221 char *argptr = arg;
7222 int hasColon = 0;
7223
7224 /* look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
7225 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
7226 function/method name */
7227 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7228 {
7229 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7230 argptr++;
7231 }
7232
7233 if (hasColon)
7234 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
7235 else
7236 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
7237 }
7238
7239 if (badInput)
7240 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
7241 else
7242 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7243 }
7244
7245 static void
7246 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7247 {
7248 int badInput = 0;
7249
7250 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
7251 badInput = 1;
7252 else
7253 {
7254 char *argptr = arg;
7255 int hasColon = 0;
7256
7257 /* look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
7258 it is probably a line number. */
7259 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7260 {
7261 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7262 argptr++;
7263 }
7264
7265 if (hasColon)
7266 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
7267 else
7268 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
7269 }
7270
7271 if (badInput)
7272 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
7273 else
7274 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7275 }
7276
7277 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
7278 hw_read: watch read,
7279 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
7280 static void
7281 watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
7282 {
7283 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7284 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
7285 struct expression *exp;
7286 struct block *exp_valid_block;
7287 struct value *val, *mark;
7288 struct frame_info *frame;
7289 char *exp_start = NULL;
7290 char *exp_end = NULL;
7291 char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
7292 int toklen;
7293 char *cond_start = NULL;
7294 char *cond_end = NULL;
7295 int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
7296 enum bptype bp_type;
7297 int mem_cnt = 0;
7298 int thread = -1;
7299
7300 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
7301 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
7302 {
7303 toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list. */
7304
7305 /* Points tok to the end of the argument list. */
7306 tok = arg + toklen - 1;
7307
7308 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last parameter.
7309 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, this should
7310 be the thread identifier. */
7311 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7312 tok--;
7313 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7314 tok--;
7315
7316 /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token. */
7317 id_tok_start = tok + 1;
7318
7319 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more parameter.
7320 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, we should
7321 reach a "thread" token. */
7322 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7323 tok--;
7324
7325 end_tok = tok;
7326
7327 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7328 tok--;
7329
7330 /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
7331 calculate the length of the token. */
7332 tok++;
7333 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7334
7335 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7336 {
7337 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
7338 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
7339 only in a specific thread. */
7340 char *endp;
7341
7342 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
7343 thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
7344
7345 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
7346 thread ID. */
7347 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7348 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
7349
7350 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
7351 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
7352 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
7353
7354 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
7355 parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
7356 evaluate_expression() function. */
7357 *tok = '\0';
7358 }
7359 }
7360
7361 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
7362 innermost_block = NULL;
7363 exp_start = arg;
7364 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
7365 exp_end = arg;
7366 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
7367 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
7368 prettier. */
7369 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
7370 --exp_end;
7371
7372 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7373 mark = value_mark ();
7374 fetch_watchpoint_value (exp, &val, NULL, NULL);
7375 if (val != NULL)
7376 release_value (val);
7377
7378 tok = arg;
7379 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
7380 tok++;
7381 end_tok = tok;
7382
7383 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
7384 end_tok++;
7385
7386 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7387 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7388 {
7389 struct expression *cond;
7390
7391 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7392 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
7393 xfree (cond);
7394 cond_end = tok;
7395 }
7396 if (*tok)
7397 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
7398
7399 if (accessflag == hw_read)
7400 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
7401 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
7402 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
7403 else
7404 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
7405
7406 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val);
7407 if (mem_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7408 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
7409 if (mem_cnt != 0)
7410 {
7411 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
7412 target_resources_ok =
7413 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + mem_cnt,
7414 other_type_used);
7415 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7416 error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
7417
7418 if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7419 error (_("Target can only support one kind of HW watchpoint at a time."));
7420 }
7421
7422 /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a hardware
7423 watchpoint could not be set. */
7424 if (!mem_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
7425 bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
7426
7427 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
7428
7429 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
7430 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
7431 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
7432 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
7433 if (innermost_block && frame)
7434 {
7435 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7436 {
7437 scope_breakpoint
7438 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7439 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
7440 bp_watchpoint_scope);
7441
7442 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7443
7444 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
7445 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
7446
7447 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
7448 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
7449
7450 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
7451 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
7452 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
7453 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
7454 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7455 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
7456 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
7457 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
7458 scope_breakpoint->type);
7459 }
7460 }
7461
7462 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
7463 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
7464 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7465 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7466 b->thread = thread;
7467 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
7468 b->exp = exp;
7469 b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
7470 b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
7471 b->val = val;
7472 b->val_valid = 1;
7473 if (cond_start)
7474 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
7475 else
7476 b->cond_string = 0;
7477
7478 if (frame)
7479 {
7480 b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
7481 b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
7482 }
7483 else
7484 {
7485 b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
7486 b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
7487 }
7488
7489 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
7490 {
7491 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
7492 need to act on them together. */
7493 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
7494 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
7495 }
7496
7497 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7498
7499 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
7500 that should be inserted. */
7501 update_watchpoint (b, 1);
7502
7503 mention (b);
7504 update_global_location_list (1);
7505 }
7506
7507 /* Return count of locations need to be watched and can be handled
7508 in hardware. If the watchpoint can not be handled
7509 in hardware return zero. */
7510
7511 static int
7512 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
7513 {
7514 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
7515 struct value *head = v;
7516
7517 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
7518 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
7519 return 0;
7520
7521 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
7522 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
7523 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
7524 hardware watchpoint.
7525
7526 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
7527 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
7528 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
7529 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
7530 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
7531 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
7532 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
7533 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
7534 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
7535
7536 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
7537 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
7538 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
7539 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
7540 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
7541 {
7542 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
7543 {
7544 if (value_lazy (v))
7545 /* A lazy memory lvalue is one that GDB never needed to fetch;
7546 we either just used its address (e.g., `a' in `a.b') or
7547 we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' in `a,b'). */
7548 ;
7549 else
7550 {
7551 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
7552 it with hardware watchpoints. */
7553 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
7554
7555 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
7556 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
7557 middle of some value chain. */
7558 if (v == head
7559 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7560 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
7561 {
7562 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
7563 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
7564
7565 if (!target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len))
7566 return 0;
7567 else
7568 found_memory_cnt++;
7569 }
7570 }
7571 }
7572 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
7573 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
7574 return 0; /* ??? What does this represent? */
7575 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
7576 return 0; /* cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint */
7577 }
7578
7579 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
7580 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
7581 return found_memory_cnt;
7582 }
7583
7584 void
7585 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7586 {
7587 watch_command (arg, from_tty);
7588 }
7589
7590 static void
7591 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7592 {
7593 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
7594 }
7595
7596 void
7597 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7598 {
7599 rwatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7600 }
7601
7602 static void
7603 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7604 {
7605 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
7606 }
7607
7608 void
7609 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7610 {
7611 awatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7612 }
7613
7614 static void
7615 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7616 {
7617 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
7618 }
7619 \f
7620
7621 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
7622 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
7623
7624 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
7625 {
7626 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7627 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
7628 };
7629
7630 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
7631 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
7632 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
7633 command. */
7634 static void
7635 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
7636 {
7637 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
7638
7639 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
7640 if (a->breakpoint2)
7641 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
7642 }
7643
7644 void
7645 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
7646 {
7647 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7648 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7649 struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
7650 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7651 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
7652 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7653
7654 clear_proceed_status ();
7655
7656 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
7657 this function */
7658
7659 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7660 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7661 default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7662 else
7663 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
7664 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7665
7666 if (sals.nelts != 1)
7667 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
7668
7669 sal = sals.sals[0];
7670 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed */
7671
7672 if (*arg)
7673 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7674
7675 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
7676
7677 if (anywhere)
7678 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
7679 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
7680 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7681 null_frame_id, bp_until);
7682 else
7683 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only
7684 at the very same frame. */
7685 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7686 get_stack_frame_id (frame),
7687 bp_until);
7688
7689 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
7690
7691 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
7692 one. */
7693
7694 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7695 {
7696 sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
7697 sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7698 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7699 sal,
7700 frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
7701 bp_until);
7702 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
7703 }
7704
7705 proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
7706
7707 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has actually
7708 managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to be
7709 deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already stopped and
7710 delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
7711
7712 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
7713 {
7714 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
7715 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
7716
7717 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
7718 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
7719
7720 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
7721 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
7722 until_break_command_continuation, args,
7723 xfree);
7724 }
7725 else
7726 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7727 }
7728
7729 static void
7730 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s)
7731 {
7732 if ((s == NULL) || (*s == NULL))
7733 return;
7734 while (isspace (**s))
7735 *s += 1;
7736 }
7737
7738 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
7739 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7740
7741 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
7742 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
7743 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
7744 if clause in the arg string. */
7745
7746 static char *
7747 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
7748 {
7749 char *cond_string;
7750
7751 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
7752 return NULL;
7753
7754 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
7755 (*arg) += 2;
7756
7757 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
7758 condition string. */
7759 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (arg);
7760 cond_string = *arg;
7761
7762 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg string. */
7763 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
7764
7765 return cond_string;
7766 }
7767
7768 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
7769 process start/exit, etc. */
7770
7771 typedef enum
7772 {
7773 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
7774 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
7775 }
7776 catch_fork_kind;
7777
7778 static void
7779 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7780 {
7781 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7782 char *cond_string = NULL;
7783 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
7784 int tempflag;
7785
7786 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
7787 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
7788 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
7789
7790 if (!arg)
7791 arg = "";
7792 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7793
7794 /* The allowed syntax is:
7795 catch [v]fork
7796 catch [v]fork if <cond>
7797
7798 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7799 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7800
7801 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7802 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7803
7804 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
7805 and enable reporting of such events. */
7806 switch (fork_kind)
7807 {
7808 case catch_fork_temporary:
7809 case catch_fork_permanent:
7810 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7811 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
7812 break;
7813 case catch_vfork_temporary:
7814 case catch_vfork_permanent:
7815 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7816 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
7817 break;
7818 default:
7819 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
7820 break;
7821 }
7822 }
7823
7824 static void
7825 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7826 {
7827 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7828 int tempflag;
7829 char *cond_string = NULL;
7830
7831 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7832
7833 if (!arg)
7834 arg = "";
7835 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7836
7837 /* The allowed syntax is:
7838 catch exec
7839 catch exec if <cond>
7840
7841 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7842 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7843
7844 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7845 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7846
7847 /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
7848 and enable reporting of such events. */
7849 create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7850 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
7851 }
7852
7853 static enum print_stop_action
7854 print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7855 {
7856 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
7857
7858 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7859
7860 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7861 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
7862 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
7863 b->loc->address,
7864 b->number, 1);
7865 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7866 ui_out_text (uiout,
7867 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
7868 : "Catchpoint ");
7869 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7870 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7871 ui_out_text (uiout,
7872 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
7873 : " (exception caught), ");
7874 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7875 {
7876 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7877 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
7878 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7879 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7880 }
7881 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7882 }
7883
7884 static void
7885 print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7886 {
7887 struct value_print_options opts;
7888 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7889 if (opts.addressprint)
7890 {
7891 annotate_field (4);
7892 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
7893 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
7894 else
7895 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
7896 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
7897 }
7898 annotate_field (5);
7899 if (b->loc)
7900 *last_loc = b->loc;
7901 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
7902 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
7903 else
7904 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
7905 }
7906
7907 static void
7908 print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7909 {
7910 int bp_temp;
7911 int bp_throw;
7912
7913 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7914 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7915 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
7916 : _("Catchpoint "));
7917 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7918 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
7919 : _(" (catch)"));
7920 }
7921
7922 static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
7923 NULL, /* insert */
7924 NULL, /* remove */
7925 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
7926 print_exception_catchpoint,
7927 print_one_exception_catchpoint,
7928 print_mention_exception_catchpoint
7929 };
7930
7931 static int
7932 handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
7933 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
7934 {
7935 char *trigger_func_name;
7936
7937 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7938 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
7939 else
7940 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
7941
7942 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
7943 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
7944 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
7945 tempflag, 0, 0,
7946 0,
7947 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
7948 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
7949 1 /* enabled */);
7950
7951 return 1;
7952 }
7953
7954 /* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands */
7955
7956 static void
7957 catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
7958 int tempflag, int from_tty)
7959 {
7960 char *cond_string = NULL;
7961 struct symtab_and_line *sal = NULL;
7962
7963 if (!arg)
7964 arg = "";
7965 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7966
7967 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7968
7969 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7970 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7971
7972 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
7973 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7974 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
7975
7976 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
7977 return;
7978
7979 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
7980 }
7981
7982 /* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
7983
7984 static void
7985 catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7986 {
7987 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7988 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7989 }
7990
7991 /* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
7992
7993 static void
7994 catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7995 {
7996 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7997 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7998 }
7999
8000 /* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints. */
8001
8002 static void
8003 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8004 struct symtab_and_line sal,
8005 char *addr_string,
8006 char *exp_string,
8007 char *cond_string,
8008 struct expression *cond,
8009 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8010 int tempflag,
8011 int from_tty)
8012 {
8013 struct breakpoint *b;
8014
8015 if (from_tty)
8016 {
8017 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8018 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8019 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8020
8021 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8022 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
8023 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
8024 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
8025 used for different exception names will use the same address.
8026 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
8027 unproductive. Besides. the warning phrasing is also a bit
8028 inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
8029 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
8030 enough for now, though. */
8031 }
8032
8033 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
8034 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
8035
8036 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8037 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8038 b->number = breakpoint_count;
8039 b->ignore_count = 0;
8040 b->loc->cond = cond;
8041 b->addr_string = addr_string;
8042 b->language = language_ada;
8043 b->cond_string = cond_string;
8044 b->exp_string = exp_string;
8045 b->thread = -1;
8046 b->ops = ops;
8047
8048 mention (b);
8049 update_global_location_list (1);
8050 }
8051
8052 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
8053
8054 static void
8055 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
8056 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8057 {
8058 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8059 int tempflag;
8060 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8061 enum bptype type;
8062 char *addr_string = NULL;
8063 char *exp_string = NULL;
8064 char *cond_string = NULL;
8065 struct expression *cond = NULL;
8066 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8067
8068 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8069
8070 if (!arg)
8071 arg = "";
8072 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
8073 &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
8074 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
8075 cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
8076 from_tty);
8077 }
8078
8079 /* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list. */
8080 static void
8081 clean_up_filters (void *arg)
8082 {
8083 VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
8084 VEC_free (int, iter);
8085 }
8086
8087 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
8088 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
8089 static VEC(int) *
8090 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
8091 {
8092 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
8093 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
8094
8095 while (*arg != '\0')
8096 {
8097 int i, syscall_number;
8098 char *endptr;
8099 char cur_name[128];
8100 struct syscall s;
8101
8102 /* Skip whitespace. */
8103 while (isspace (*arg))
8104 arg++;
8105
8106 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
8107 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
8108 cur_name[i] = '\0';
8109 arg += i;
8110
8111 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
8112 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
8113 if (*endptr == '\0')
8114 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
8115 else
8116 {
8117 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
8118 to a number. */
8119 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
8120
8121 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
8122 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning, because
8123 GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no syscall number to
8124 be caught. */
8125 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
8126 }
8127
8128 /* Ok, it's valid. */
8129 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
8130 }
8131
8132 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8133 return result;
8134 }
8135
8136 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
8137
8138 static void
8139 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8140 {
8141 int tempflag;
8142 VEC(int) *filter;
8143 struct syscall s;
8144 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8145
8146 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
8147 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
8148 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
8149 this architeture yet."));
8150
8151 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8152
8153 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8154
8155 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
8156 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
8157 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
8158 for his/her architecture. */
8159 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
8160
8161 /* The allowed syntax is:
8162 catch syscall
8163 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
8164
8165 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
8166
8167 if (arg != NULL)
8168 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
8169 else
8170 filter = NULL;
8171
8172 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
8173 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8174 }
8175
8176 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
8177
8178 static void
8179 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8180 {
8181 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8182 int tempflag;
8183 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8184 char *addr_string = NULL;
8185 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8186
8187 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8188
8189 if (!arg)
8190 arg = "";
8191 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
8192 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
8193 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
8194 }
8195
8196 static void
8197 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8198 {
8199 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8200 }
8201 \f
8202
8203 static void
8204 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8205 {
8206 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8207 }
8208
8209 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
8210
8211 static void
8212 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8213 {
8214 struct breakpoint *b;
8215 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
8216 int ix;
8217 int default_match;
8218 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8219 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8220 int i;
8221
8222 if (arg)
8223 {
8224 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
8225 default_match = 0;
8226 }
8227 else
8228 {
8229 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
8230 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
8231 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
8232 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
8233 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
8234 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
8235 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
8236 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
8237 if (sal.symtab == 0)
8238 error (_("No source file specified."));
8239
8240 sals.sals[0] = sal;
8241 sals.nelts = 1;
8242
8243 default_match = 1;
8244 }
8245
8246 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not
8247 as bad as it seems, because all existing breakpoints
8248 typically have both file/line and pc set. So, if
8249 clear is given file/line, we can match this to existing
8250 breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
8251
8252 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
8253 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
8254 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
8255 due to optimization, all in one block.
8256 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
8257 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
8258 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
8259 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
8260 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
8261 to support that. */
8262
8263 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond
8264 to it. Do it in two passes, solely to preserve the current
8265 behavior that from_tty is forced true if we delete more than
8266 one breakpoint. */
8267
8268 found = NULL;
8269 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
8270 {
8271 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
8272 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
8273 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
8274 or at default pc.
8275
8276 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
8277
8278 0 1 pc
8279 1 1 pc _and_ line
8280 0 0 line
8281 1 0 <can't happen> */
8282
8283 sal = sals.sals[i];
8284
8285 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to
8286 'found'. */
8287 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8288 {
8289 int match = 0;
8290 /* Are we going to delete b? */
8291 if (b->type != bp_none
8292 && b->type != bp_watchpoint
8293 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
8294 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
8295 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
8296 {
8297 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
8298 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8299 {
8300 int pc_match = sal.pc
8301 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
8302 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
8303 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
8304 || loc->section == sal.section);
8305 int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
8306 && b->source_file != NULL
8307 && sal.symtab != NULL
8308 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
8309 && strcmp (b->source_file, sal.symtab->filename) == 0
8310 && b->line_number == sal.line);
8311 if (pc_match || line_match)
8312 {
8313 match = 1;
8314 break;
8315 }
8316 }
8317 }
8318
8319 if (match)
8320 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
8321 }
8322 }
8323 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
8324 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
8325 {
8326 if (arg)
8327 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
8328 else
8329 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
8330 }
8331
8332 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
8333 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one */
8334 if (from_tty)
8335 {
8336 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
8337 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
8338 else
8339 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
8340 }
8341 breakpoints_changed ();
8342
8343 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
8344 {
8345 if (from_tty)
8346 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
8347 delete_breakpoint (b);
8348 }
8349 if (from_tty)
8350 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
8351 }
8352 \f
8353 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
8354 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
8355 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
8356
8357 void
8358 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
8359 {
8360 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8361
8362 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
8363 if (bs->breakpoint_at
8364 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
8365 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del
8366 && bs->stop)
8367 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner);
8368
8369 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8370 {
8371 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
8372 delete_breakpoint (b);
8373 }
8374 }
8375
8376 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to qsort.
8377 Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what does
8378 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER), secondarily by ordering
8379 first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and terciarily just ensuring the array
8380 is sorted stable way despite qsort being an instable algorithm. */
8381
8382 static int
8383 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
8384 {
8385 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
8386 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
8387 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8388 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8389
8390 if (a->address != b->address)
8391 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
8392
8393 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
8394 if (a_perm != b_perm)
8395 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
8396
8397 /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs. Locations of the same
8398 breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
8399
8400 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
8401 return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
8402 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
8403
8404 return (a > b) - (a < b);
8405 }
8406
8407 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
8408 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current content of
8409 the bp_location array. */
8410
8411 static void
8412 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
8413 {
8414 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
8415
8416 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
8417 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
8418
8419 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
8420 {
8421 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
8422
8423 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
8424 continue;
8425
8426 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
8427 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
8428
8429 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
8430 addr = bl->address - start;
8431 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
8432 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
8433
8434 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
8435
8436 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
8437 addr = end - bl->address;
8438 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
8439 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
8440 }
8441 }
8442
8443 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
8444 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
8445 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
8446 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
8447 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
8448 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
8449 returns true on them.
8450
8451 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
8452 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
8453 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
8454 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
8455 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
8456 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
8457
8458 static void
8459 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
8460 {
8461 struct breakpoint *b;
8462 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
8463 struct cleanup *cleanups;
8464
8465 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
8466 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
8467 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
8468 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
8469 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
8470 once. */
8471 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
8472 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
8473 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
8474 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
8475
8476 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly built
8477 bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
8478 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
8479 unsigned old_location_count;
8480
8481 old_location = bp_location;
8482 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
8483 bp_location = NULL;
8484 bp_location_count = 0;
8485 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
8486
8487 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8488 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8489 bp_location_count++;
8490
8491 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
8492 locp = bp_location;
8493 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8494 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8495 *locp++ = loc;
8496 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
8497 bp_location_compare);
8498
8499 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
8500
8501 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the new
8502 list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not necessary that
8503 those locations should be removed from inferior -- if there's another
8504 location at the same address (previously marked as duplicate),
8505 we don't need to remove/insert the location.
8506
8507 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current and
8508 former bp_location array state respectively. */
8509
8510 locp = bp_location;
8511 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
8512 old_locp++)
8513 {
8514 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
8515 struct bp_location **loc2p;
8516
8517 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations. If not, we
8518 have to free it. */
8519 int found_object = 0;
8520 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
8521 int keep_in_target = 0;
8522 int removed = 0;
8523
8524 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. Stop either
8525 at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
8526 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
8527 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
8528 locp++;
8529
8530 for (loc2p = locp;
8531 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8532 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8533 loc2p++)
8534 {
8535 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
8536 {
8537 found_object = 1;
8538 break;
8539 }
8540 }
8541
8542 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if there's
8543 maybe a new location at the same address. If so, mark that one
8544 inserted, and don't remove this one. This is needed so that we
8545 don't have a time window where a breakpoint at certain location is not
8546 inserted. */
8547
8548 if (old_loc->inserted)
8549 {
8550 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove it. */
8551
8552 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
8553 {
8554 /* The location is still present in the location list, and still
8555 should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
8556 keep_in_target = 1;
8557 }
8558 else
8559 {
8560 /* The location is either no longer present, or got disabled.
8561 See if there's another location at the same address, in which
8562 case we don't need to remove this one from the target. */
8563
8564 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
8565 {
8566 for (loc2p = locp;
8567 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8568 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8569 loc2p++)
8570 {
8571 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
8572
8573 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
8574 {
8575 /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
8576 Duplicates check below will fix up this later. */
8577 loc2->duplicate = 0;
8578
8579 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
8580 access watchpoints, if the former are not
8581 supported, but the latter are. */
8582 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8583 {
8584 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
8585 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
8586 }
8587
8588 if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
8589 {
8590 loc2->inserted = 1;
8591 loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
8592 keep_in_target = 1;
8593 break;
8594 }
8595 }
8596 }
8597 }
8598 }
8599
8600 if (!keep_in_target)
8601 {
8602 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
8603 {
8604 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep this
8605 location on the global list, and try to remove it next
8606 time, but there's no particular reason why we will
8607 succeed next time.
8608
8609 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still valid,
8610 as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint only
8611 after calling us. */
8612 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing breakpoint %d\n"),
8613 old_loc->owner->number);
8614 }
8615 removed = 1;
8616 }
8617 }
8618
8619 if (!found_object)
8620 {
8621 if (removed && non_stop
8622 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
8623 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8624 {
8625 /* This location was removed from the target. In
8626 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
8627 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
8628 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
8629 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
8630 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
8631 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
8632 after we see some number of events. The theory here
8633 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
8634 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
8635 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
8636 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
8637 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
8638 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
8639 SIGTRAP.
8640
8641 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
8642 decr_pc_after_break targets.
8643
8644 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
8645 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
8646 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
8647 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
8648 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
8649 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
8650 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SEGSEGV, or worse, get silently
8651 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
8652 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
8653 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
8654 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
8655 targets that do not support new thread events, like
8656 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
8657 thread_count.
8658
8659 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
8660 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
8661 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
8662 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
8663
8664 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
8665 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
8666 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
8667 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
8668 traps we can no longer explain. */
8669
8670 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
8671 old_loc->owner = NULL;
8672
8673 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
8674 }
8675 else
8676 free_bp_location (old_loc);
8677 }
8678 }
8679
8680 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
8681 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
8682 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
8683 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
8684 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
8685 are sorted first for the same address.
8686
8687 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
8688 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
8689
8690 bp_loc_first = NULL;
8691 wp_loc_first = NULL;
8692 awp_loc_first = NULL;
8693 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
8694 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
8695 {
8696 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
8697 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
8698
8699 if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
8700 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
8701 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
8702 || !loc->enabled
8703 || loc->shlib_disabled
8704 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
8705 || tracepoint_type (b))
8706 continue;
8707
8708 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
8709 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
8710 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8711 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
8712 "actually inserted"));
8713
8714 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8715 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
8716 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
8717 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
8718 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
8719 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
8720 else
8721 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
8722
8723 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
8724 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
8725 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
8726 {
8727 *loc_first_p = loc;
8728 loc->duplicate = 0;
8729 continue;
8730 }
8731
8732 loc->duplicate = 1;
8733
8734 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
8735 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
8736 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8737 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
8738 "a permanent breakpoint"));
8739 }
8740
8741 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
8742 && (have_live_inferiors ()
8743 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
8744 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
8745
8746 do_cleanups (cleanups);
8747 }
8748
8749 void
8750 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
8751 {
8752 struct bp_location *loc;
8753 int ix;
8754
8755 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
8756 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
8757 {
8758 free_bp_location (loc);
8759 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
8760 --ix;
8761 }
8762 }
8763
8764 static void
8765 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
8766 {
8767 struct gdb_exception e;
8768 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8769 update_global_location_list (inserting);
8770 }
8771
8772 /* Clear BPT from a BPS. */
8773 static void
8774 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
8775 {
8776 bpstat bs;
8777 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
8778 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->owner == bpt)
8779 {
8780 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
8781 bs->old_val = NULL;
8782 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
8783 }
8784 }
8785
8786 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
8787 static int
8788 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
8789 {
8790 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
8791 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (th->stop_bpstat, bpt);
8792 return 0;
8793 }
8794
8795 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
8796 structures. */
8797
8798 void
8799 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
8800 {
8801 struct breakpoint *b;
8802 struct bp_location *loc, *next;
8803
8804 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
8805
8806 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because multiple
8807 lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are especial culprits.
8808
8809 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When the
8810 scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of scope, and
8811 delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the scope bp is marked
8812 "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. That bpstat is then
8813 checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are deleted.
8814
8815 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in bp's,
8816 and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing bpstat's, and
8817 teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's storage when no more
8818 references were extent. A cheaper bandaid was chosen. */
8819 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
8820 return;
8821
8822 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting of
8823 breakpoints gets resolved. */
8824 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != NULL)
8825 {
8826 gdb_assert (bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == bpt);
8827 bpt->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
8828 bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
8829 bpt->related_breakpoint = NULL;
8830 }
8831
8832 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
8833
8834 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
8835 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
8836
8837 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8838 if (b->next == bpt)
8839 {
8840 b->next = bpt->next;
8841 break;
8842 }
8843
8844 free_command_lines (&bpt->commands);
8845 if (bpt->cond_string != NULL)
8846 xfree (bpt->cond_string);
8847 if (bpt->addr_string != NULL)
8848 xfree (bpt->addr_string);
8849 if (bpt->exp != NULL)
8850 xfree (bpt->exp);
8851 if (bpt->exp_string != NULL)
8852 xfree (bpt->exp_string);
8853 if (bpt->val != NULL)
8854 value_free (bpt->val);
8855 if (bpt->source_file != NULL)
8856 xfree (bpt->source_file);
8857 if (bpt->exec_pathname != NULL)
8858 xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
8859 clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
8860
8861 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at it after it's been freed. */
8862 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?
8863 We just check stop_bpstat for now. Note that we cannot just
8864 remove bpstats pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list
8865 entirely, as breakpoint commands are associated with the bpstat;
8866 if we remove it here, then the later call to
8867 bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat);
8868 in event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints
8869 with commands won't work. */
8870
8871 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
8872
8873 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint
8874 list, update the global location list. This
8875 will remove locations that used to belong to
8876 this breakpoint. Do this before freeing
8877 the breakpoint itself, since remove_breakpoint
8878 looks at location's owner. It might be better
8879 design to have location completely self-contained,
8880 but it's not the case now. */
8881 update_global_location_list (0);
8882
8883
8884 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this same
8885 bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
8886 bpt->type = bp_none;
8887
8888 xfree (bpt);
8889 }
8890
8891 static void
8892 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
8893 {
8894 delete_breakpoint (b);
8895 }
8896
8897 struct cleanup *
8898 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8899 {
8900 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
8901 }
8902
8903 void
8904 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8905 {
8906 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8907
8908 dont_repeat ();
8909
8910 if (arg == 0)
8911 {
8912 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
8913
8914 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
8915 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
8916 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
8917 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8918 {
8919 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8920 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8921 && b->type != bp_jit_event
8922 && b->type != bp_thread_event
8923 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8924 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8925 && b->number >= 0)
8926 {
8927 breaks_to_delete = 1;
8928 break;
8929 }
8930 }
8931
8932 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
8933 if (!from_tty
8934 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
8935 {
8936 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8937 {
8938 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8939 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8940 && b->type != bp_thread_event
8941 && b->type != bp_jit_event
8942 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8943 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8944 && b->number >= 0)
8945 delete_breakpoint (b);
8946 }
8947 }
8948 }
8949 else
8950 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
8951 }
8952
8953 static int
8954 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
8955 {
8956 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8957 if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
8958 return 0;
8959 return 1;
8960 }
8961
8962 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
8963 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
8964 Null names are ignored. */
8965
8966 static int
8967 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
8968 {
8969 struct bp_location *l;
8970 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
8971 (int (*) (const void *, const void *)) streq,
8972 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
8973
8974 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
8975 {
8976 const char **slot;
8977 const char *name = l->function_name;
8978
8979 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
8980 if (name == NULL)
8981 continue;
8982
8983 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
8984 INSERT);
8985 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never returns
8986 NULL. */
8987 if (*slot != NULL)
8988 {
8989 htab_delete (htab);
8990 return 1;
8991 }
8992 *slot = name;
8993 }
8994
8995 htab_delete (htab);
8996 return 0;
8997 }
8998
8999 static void
9000 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
9001 struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
9002 {
9003 int i;
9004 char *s;
9005 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
9006
9007 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations
9008 are pending, don't do anything. This optimizes
9009 the common case where all locations are in the same
9010 shared library, that was unloaded. We'd like to
9011 retain the location, so that when the library
9012 is loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled
9013 status of the individual locations. */
9014 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
9015 return;
9016
9017 b->loc = NULL;
9018
9019 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
9020 {
9021 struct bp_location *new_loc =
9022 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
9023
9024 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
9025 old symtab. */
9026 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
9027 {
9028 struct gdb_exception e;
9029
9030 s = b->cond_string;
9031 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9032 {
9033 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
9034 0);
9035 }
9036 if (e.reason < 0)
9037 {
9038 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition for breakpoint %d: %s"),
9039 b->number, e.message);
9040 new_loc->enabled = 0;
9041 }
9042 }
9043
9044 if (b->source_file != NULL)
9045 xfree (b->source_file);
9046 if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
9047 b->source_file = NULL;
9048 else
9049 b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
9050
9051 if (b->line_number == 0)
9052 b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
9053 }
9054
9055 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
9056 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9057 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
9058
9059 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing breakpoints. */
9060 {
9061 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
9062 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
9063 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
9064 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
9065 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
9066 often enough until a better solution is found. */
9067 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
9068
9069 for (; e; e = e->next)
9070 {
9071 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
9072 {
9073 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
9074 if (have_ambiguous_names)
9075 {
9076 for (; l; l = l->next)
9077 if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
9078 l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
9079 {
9080 l->enabled = 0;
9081 break;
9082 }
9083 }
9084 else
9085 {
9086 for (; l; l = l->next)
9087 if (l->function_name
9088 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
9089 {
9090 l->enabled = 0;
9091 break;
9092 }
9093 }
9094 }
9095 }
9096 }
9097
9098 update_global_location_list (1);
9099 }
9100
9101
9102 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
9103 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
9104 Unused in this case. */
9105
9106 static int
9107 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
9108 {
9109 /* get past catch_errs */
9110 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
9111 struct value *mark;
9112 int i;
9113 int not_found = 0;
9114 int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
9115 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
9116 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
9117 char *s;
9118 enum enable_state save_enable;
9119 struct gdb_exception e;
9120 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
9121
9122 switch (b->type)
9123 {
9124 case bp_none:
9125 warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9126 b->number);
9127 return 0;
9128 case bp_breakpoint:
9129 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9130 case bp_tracepoint:
9131 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9132 /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup. */
9133 if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
9134 return 0;
9135
9136 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
9137 {
9138 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
9139 delete_breakpoint (b);
9140 return 0;
9141 }
9142
9143 set_language (b->language);
9144 input_radix = b->input_radix;
9145 s = b->addr_string;
9146
9147 save_current_space_and_thread ();
9148 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
9149
9150 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9151 {
9152 sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL,
9153 not_found_ptr);
9154 }
9155 if (e.reason < 0)
9156 {
9157 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
9158 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing
9159 will fail until the right shared library is loaded.
9160 User has already told to create pending breakpoints and
9161 don't need extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
9162 state, then user already saw the message about that breakpoint
9163 being disabled, and don't want to see more errors. */
9164 if (not_found
9165 && (b->condition_not_parsed
9166 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
9167 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
9168 not_found_and_ok = 1;
9169
9170 if (!not_found_and_ok)
9171 {
9172 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
9173 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
9174 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
9175 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
9176 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
9177 which approach is better. */
9178 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9179 throw_exception (e);
9180 }
9181 }
9182
9183 if (!not_found)
9184 {
9185 gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
9186
9187 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
9188 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
9189 {
9190 char *cond_string = 0;
9191 int thread = -1;
9192 int task = 0;
9193
9194 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
9195 &cond_string, &thread, &task);
9196 if (cond_string)
9197 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9198 b->thread = thread;
9199 b->task = task;
9200 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
9201 }
9202
9203 expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
9204 }
9205
9206 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
9207 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
9208 break;
9209
9210 case bp_watchpoint:
9211 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9212 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9213 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9214 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global variables,
9215 or it can be on local variables.
9216
9217 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even persist
9218 across program restarts. Since they can use variables from shared
9219 libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries are loaded
9220 and unloaded.
9221
9222 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
9223 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local and
9224 a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, but
9225 unloading of a shared library will make the expression invalid.
9226 This is not a very common use case, but we still re-evaluate
9227 expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
9228
9229 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
9230 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means
9231 the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
9232 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
9233
9234 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
9235 b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
9236
9237 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
9238 be reevaluated again when enabled. */
9239 update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
9240 break;
9241 /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
9242 that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
9243 loaded. */
9244 case bp_catchpoint:
9245 break;
9246
9247 default:
9248 printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
9249 /* fall through */
9250 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
9251 reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
9252 case bp_overlay_event:
9253 case bp_longjmp_master:
9254 delete_breakpoint (b);
9255 break;
9256
9257 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
9258 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
9259 case bp_shlib_event:
9260
9261 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
9262 Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
9263 case bp_thread_event:
9264
9265 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
9266 over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the breakpoints.
9267 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
9268 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
9269 case bp_until:
9270 case bp_finish:
9271 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
9272 case bp_call_dummy:
9273 case bp_step_resume:
9274 case bp_longjmp:
9275 case bp_longjmp_resume:
9276 case bp_jit_event:
9277 break;
9278 }
9279
9280 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9281 return 0;
9282 }
9283
9284 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
9285 void
9286 breakpoint_re_set (void)
9287 {
9288 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9289 enum language save_language;
9290 int save_input_radix;
9291 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9292
9293 save_language = current_language->la_language;
9294 save_input_radix = input_radix;
9295 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
9296
9297 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9298 {
9299 /* Format possible error msg */
9300 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
9301 b->number);
9302 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
9303 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
9304 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9305 }
9306 set_language (save_language);
9307 input_radix = save_input_radix;
9308
9309 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
9310
9311 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9312
9313 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
9314 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
9315 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
9316 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
9317 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
9318 }
9319 \f
9320 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
9321
9322 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
9323 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
9324 void
9325 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
9326 {
9327 if (b->thread != -1)
9328 {
9329 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
9330 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
9331
9332 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
9333 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
9334 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
9335 as well. */
9336 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
9337 }
9338 }
9339
9340 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9341 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9342 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9343
9344 void
9345 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
9346 {
9347 struct breakpoint *b;
9348
9349 if (count < 0)
9350 count = 0;
9351
9352 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9353 if (b->number == bptnum)
9354 {
9355 b->ignore_count = count;
9356 if (from_tty)
9357 {
9358 if (count == 0)
9359 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time breakpoint %d is reached."),
9360 bptnum);
9361 else if (count == 1)
9362 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
9363 bptnum);
9364 else
9365 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d crossings of breakpoint %d."),
9366 count, bptnum);
9367 }
9368 breakpoints_changed ();
9369 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
9370 return;
9371 }
9372
9373 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
9374 }
9375
9376 void
9377 make_breakpoint_silent (struct breakpoint *b)
9378 {
9379 /* Silence the breakpoint. */
9380 b->silent = 1;
9381 }
9382
9383 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
9384
9385 static void
9386 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9387 {
9388 char *p = args;
9389 int num;
9390
9391 if (p == 0)
9392 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
9393
9394 num = get_number (&p);
9395 if (num == 0)
9396 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
9397 if (*p == 0)
9398 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
9399
9400 set_ignore_count (num,
9401 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
9402 from_tty);
9403 if (from_tty)
9404 printf_filtered ("\n");
9405 }
9406 \f
9407 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
9408 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
9409
9410 static void
9411 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *))
9412 {
9413 char *p = args;
9414 char *p1;
9415 int num;
9416 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
9417 int match;
9418
9419 if (p == 0)
9420 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
9421
9422 while (*p)
9423 {
9424 match = 0;
9425 p1 = p;
9426
9427 num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9428 if (num == 0)
9429 {
9430 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
9431 }
9432 else
9433 {
9434 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
9435 if (b->number == num)
9436 {
9437 struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
9438 match = 1;
9439 function (b);
9440 if (related_breakpoint)
9441 function (related_breakpoint);
9442 break;
9443 }
9444 if (match == 0)
9445 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
9446 }
9447 p = p1;
9448 }
9449 }
9450
9451 static struct bp_location *
9452 find_location_by_number (char *number)
9453 {
9454 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
9455 char *p1;
9456 int bp_num;
9457 int loc_num;
9458 struct breakpoint *b;
9459 struct bp_location *loc;
9460
9461 *dot = '\0';
9462
9463 p1 = number;
9464 bp_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9465 if (bp_num == 0)
9466 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9467
9468 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9469 if (b->number == bp_num)
9470 {
9471 break;
9472 }
9473
9474 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
9475 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9476
9477 p1 = dot+1;
9478 loc_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9479 if (loc_num == 0)
9480 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
9481
9482 --loc_num;
9483 loc = b->loc;
9484 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
9485 ;
9486 if (!loc)
9487 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
9488
9489 return loc;
9490 }
9491
9492
9493 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9494 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9495 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9496
9497 void
9498 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9499 {
9500 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
9501 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
9502 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
9503 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
9504 return;
9505
9506 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
9507 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9508 return;
9509
9510 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9511
9512 update_global_location_list (0);
9513
9514 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9515 }
9516
9517 static void
9518 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9519 {
9520 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9521 if (args == 0)
9522 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9523 switch (bpt->type)
9524 {
9525 case bp_none:
9526 warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9527 bpt->number);
9528 continue;
9529 case bp_breakpoint:
9530 case bp_tracepoint:
9531 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9532 case bp_catchpoint:
9533 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9534 case bp_watchpoint:
9535 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9536 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9537 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9538 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
9539 default:
9540 continue;
9541 }
9542 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9543 {
9544 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9545 if (loc)
9546 loc->enabled = 0;
9547 update_global_location_list (0);
9548 }
9549 else
9550 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, disable_breakpoint);
9551 }
9552
9553 static void
9554 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
9555 {
9556 int target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
9557 struct value *mark;
9558
9559 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9560 {
9561 int i;
9562 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9563 target_resources_ok =
9564 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9565 i + 1, 0);
9566 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9567 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9568 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9569 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9570 }
9571
9572 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint
9573 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9574 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
9575 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9576 {
9577 struct gdb_exception e;
9578
9579 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9580 {
9581 update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
9582 }
9583 if (e.reason < 0)
9584 {
9585 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
9586 bpt->number);
9587 return;
9588 }
9589 }
9590
9591 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9592 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9593 bpt->disposition = disposition;
9594 update_global_location_list (1);
9595 breakpoints_changed ();
9596
9597 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9598 }
9599
9600
9601 void
9602 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9603 {
9604 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
9605 }
9606
9607 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
9608 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
9609 in stopping the inferior. */
9610
9611 static void
9612 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9613 {
9614 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9615 if (args == 0)
9616 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9617 switch (bpt->type)
9618 {
9619 case bp_none:
9620 warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9621 bpt->number);
9622 continue;
9623 case bp_breakpoint:
9624 case bp_tracepoint:
9625 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9626 case bp_catchpoint:
9627 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9628 case bp_watchpoint:
9629 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9630 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9631 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9632 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
9633 default:
9634 continue;
9635 }
9636 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9637 {
9638 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9639 if (loc)
9640 loc->enabled = 1;
9641 update_global_location_list (1);
9642 }
9643 else
9644 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_breakpoint);
9645 }
9646
9647 static void
9648 enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9649 {
9650 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
9651 }
9652
9653 static void
9654 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9655 {
9656 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint);
9657 }
9658
9659 static void
9660 enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9661 {
9662 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
9663 }
9664
9665 static void
9666 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9667 {
9668 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint);
9669 }
9670 \f
9671 static void
9672 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9673 {
9674 }
9675
9676 static void
9677 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9678 {
9679 }
9680
9681 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
9682 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
9683 GDB itself. */
9684
9685 static void
9686 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
9687 const bfd_byte *data)
9688 {
9689 struct breakpoint *bp;
9690
9691 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9692 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
9693 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9694 && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
9695 {
9696 struct bp_location *loc;
9697
9698 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
9699 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
9700 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
9701 && addr + len > loc->address)
9702 {
9703 value_free (bp->val);
9704 bp->val = NULL;
9705 bp->val_valid = 0;
9706 }
9707 }
9708 }
9709
9710 /* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid. */
9711
9712 struct symtabs_and_lines
9713 decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
9714 {
9715 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9716 if (string == 0)
9717 error (_("Empty line specification."));
9718 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
9719 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9720 default_breakpoint_symtab,
9721 default_breakpoint_line,
9722 (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9723 else
9724 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9725 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9726 if (*string)
9727 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
9728 return sals;
9729 }
9730
9731 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
9732 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
9733 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
9734 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
9735 someday. */
9736
9737 void *
9738 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9739 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9740 {
9741 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
9742
9743 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
9744
9745 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
9746 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
9747
9748 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
9749 {
9750 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
9751 xfree (bp_tgt);
9752 return NULL;
9753 }
9754
9755 return bp_tgt;
9756 }
9757
9758 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
9759
9760 int
9761 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
9762 {
9763 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
9764 int ret;
9765
9766 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
9767 xfree (bp_tgt);
9768
9769 return ret;
9770 }
9771
9772 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single stepping. */
9773
9774 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
9775 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
9776
9777 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
9778
9779 void
9780 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9781 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR next_pc)
9782 {
9783 void **bpt_p;
9784
9785 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
9786 {
9787 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
9788 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
9789 }
9790 else
9791 {
9792 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
9793 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
9794 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
9795 }
9796
9797 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would be
9798 to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on the
9799 breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint. We could
9800 adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing this requires
9801 corresponding changes elsewhere where single step breakpoints are
9802 handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
9803
9804 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
9805 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
9806 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
9807 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
9808 }
9809
9810 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
9811
9812 void
9813 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
9814 {
9815 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
9816
9817 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
9818 call. */
9819 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
9820 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
9821 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
9822 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
9823
9824 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
9825 {
9826 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
9827 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
9828 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
9829 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
9830 }
9831 }
9832
9833 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at PC. */
9834
9835 static int
9836 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9837 {
9838 int i;
9839
9840 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
9841 {
9842 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
9843 if (bp_tgt
9844 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
9845 bp_tgt->placed_address,
9846 aspace, pc))
9847 return 1;
9848 }
9849
9850 return 0;
9851 }
9852
9853 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
9854 non-zero otherwise. */
9855 static int
9856 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
9857 {
9858 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
9859 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
9860 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
9861 return 1;
9862 else
9863 return 0;
9864 }
9865
9866 int
9867 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
9868 {
9869 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
9870
9871 return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
9872 }
9873
9874 int
9875 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
9876 {
9877 struct breakpoint *bp;
9878
9879 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9880 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
9881 {
9882 if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
9883 {
9884 int i, iter;
9885 for (i = 0;
9886 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
9887 i++)
9888 if (syscall_number == iter)
9889 return 1;
9890 }
9891 else
9892 return 1;
9893 }
9894
9895 return 0;
9896 }
9897
9898 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
9899 static char **
9900 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
9901 char *text, char *word)
9902 {
9903 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
9904 return (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
9905 }
9906
9907 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
9908
9909 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
9910 static void
9911 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
9912 {
9913 tracepoint_count = num;
9914 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
9915 }
9916
9917 void
9918 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9919 {
9920 if (break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9921 arg,
9922 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9923 0 /* tempflag */, 0 /* hardwareflag */,
9924 1 /* traceflag */,
9925 0 /* Ignore count */,
9926 pending_break_support,
9927 NULL,
9928 from_tty,
9929 1 /* enabled */))
9930 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9931 }
9932
9933 void
9934 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9935 {
9936 if (break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9937 arg,
9938 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9939 0 /* tempflag */, 1 /* hardwareflag */,
9940 1 /* traceflag */,
9941 0 /* Ignore count */,
9942 pending_break_support,
9943 NULL,
9944 from_tty,
9945 1 /* enabled */))
9946 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9947 }
9948
9949 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
9950 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
9951 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
9952 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
9953 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
9954
9955 struct breakpoint *
9956 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
9957 {
9958 char buf[100];
9959 struct breakpoint *tp;
9960
9961 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw address. */
9962 sprintf (buf, "*%s", paddress (get_current_arch(), utp->addr));
9963
9964 if (!break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9965 buf,
9966 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9967 0 /* tempflag */,
9968 (utp->type == bp_fast_tracepoint) /* hardwareflag */,
9969 1 /* traceflag */,
9970 0 /* Ignore count */,
9971 pending_break_support,
9972 NULL,
9973 0 /* from_tty */,
9974 utp->enabled /* enabled */))
9975 return NULL;
9976
9977 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9978
9979 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
9980 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
9981
9982 if (utp->pass > 0)
9983 {
9984 sprintf (buf, "%d %d", utp->pass, tp->number);
9985
9986 trace_pass_command (buf, 0);
9987 }
9988
9989 if (utp->cond)
9990 {
9991 printf_filtered ("Want to restore a condition\n");
9992 }
9993
9994 if (utp->numactions > 0)
9995 {
9996 printf_filtered ("Want to restore action list\n");
9997 }
9998
9999 if (utp->num_step_actions > 0)
10000 {
10001 printf_filtered ("Want to restore action list\n");
10002 }
10003
10004 return tp;
10005 }
10006
10007 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
10008 omitted. */
10009
10010 static void
10011 tracepoints_info (char *tpnum_exp, int from_tty)
10012 {
10013 struct breakpoint *b;
10014 int tps_to_list = 0;
10015
10016 /* In the no-arguments case, say "No tracepoints" if none found. */
10017 if (tpnum_exp == 0)
10018 {
10019 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
10020 {
10021 if (b->number >= 0)
10022 {
10023 tps_to_list = 1;
10024 break;
10025 }
10026 }
10027 if (!tps_to_list)
10028 {
10029 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
10030 return;
10031 }
10032 }
10033
10034 /* Otherwise be the same as "info break". */
10035 breakpoints_info (tpnum_exp, from_tty);
10036 }
10037
10038 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
10039 Not supported by all targets. */
10040 static void
10041 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10042 {
10043 enable_command (args, from_tty);
10044 }
10045
10046 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
10047 Not supported by all targets. */
10048 static void
10049 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10050 {
10051 disable_command (args, from_tty);
10052 }
10053
10054 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument) */
10055 static void
10056 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10057 {
10058 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
10059
10060 dont_repeat ();
10061
10062 if (arg == 0)
10063 {
10064 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
10065
10066 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
10067 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
10068 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
10069 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
10070 {
10071 if (b->number >= 0)
10072 {
10073 breaks_to_delete = 1;
10074 break;
10075 }
10076 }
10077
10078 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
10079 if (!from_tty
10080 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
10081 {
10082 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
10083 {
10084 if (tracepoint_type (b)
10085 && b->number >= 0)
10086 delete_breakpoint (b);
10087 }
10088 }
10089 }
10090 else
10091 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
10092 }
10093
10094 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
10095
10096 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
10097 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
10098 Also accepts special argument "all". */
10099
10100 static void
10101 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10102 {
10103 struct breakpoint *t1 = (struct breakpoint *) -1, *t2;
10104 unsigned int count;
10105 int all = 0;
10106
10107 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
10108 error (_("passcount command requires an argument (count + optional TP num)"));
10109
10110 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
10111
10112 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
10113 args++;
10114
10115 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
10116 {
10117 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
10118 all = 1;
10119 if (*args)
10120 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
10121 }
10122 else
10123 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 1);
10124
10125 do
10126 {
10127 if (t1)
10128 {
10129 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t2)
10130 if (t1 == (struct breakpoint *) -1 || t1 == t2)
10131 {
10132 t2->pass_count = count;
10133 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (t2->number);
10134 if (from_tty)
10135 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
10136 t2->number, count);
10137 }
10138 if (! all && *args)
10139 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 0);
10140 }
10141 }
10142 while (*args);
10143 }
10144
10145 struct breakpoint *
10146 get_tracepoint (int num)
10147 {
10148 struct breakpoint *t;
10149
10150 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10151 if (t->number == num)
10152 return t;
10153
10154 return NULL;
10155 }
10156
10157 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
10158 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
10159 reconnecting). */
10160
10161 struct breakpoint *
10162 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
10163 {
10164 struct breakpoint *t;
10165
10166 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10167 if (t->number_on_target == num)
10168 return t;
10169
10170 return NULL;
10171 }
10172
10173 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
10174 If MULTI_P is true, there might be a range of tracepoints in ARG.
10175 if OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
10176 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
10177 struct breakpoint *
10178 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, int multi_p, int optional_p)
10179 {
10180 extern int tracepoint_count;
10181 struct breakpoint *t;
10182 int tpnum;
10183 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
10184
10185 if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
10186 {
10187 if (optional_p)
10188 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
10189 else
10190 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
10191 }
10192 else
10193 tpnum = multi_p ? get_number_or_range (arg) : get_number (arg);
10194
10195 if (tpnum <= 0)
10196 {
10197 if (instring && *instring)
10198 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
10199 instring);
10200 else
10201 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing and no previous tracepoint\n"));
10202 return NULL;
10203 }
10204
10205 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10206 if (t->number == tpnum)
10207 {
10208 return t;
10209 }
10210
10211 /* FIXME: if we are in the middle of a range we don't want to give
10212 a message. The current interface to get_number_or_range doesn't
10213 allow us to discover this. */
10214 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
10215 return NULL;
10216 }
10217
10218 /* save-tracepoints command */
10219 static void
10220 tracepoint_save_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10221 {
10222 struct breakpoint *tp;
10223 int any_tp = 0;
10224 struct action_line *line;
10225 FILE *fp;
10226 char *i1 = " ", *i2 = " ";
10227 char *indent, *actionline, *pathname;
10228 char tmp[40];
10229 struct cleanup *cleanup;
10230
10231 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
10232 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save tracepoints)"));
10233
10234 /* See if we have anything to save. */
10235 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10236 {
10237 any_tp = 1;
10238 break;
10239 }
10240 if (!any_tp)
10241 {
10242 warning (_("save-tracepoints: no tracepoints to save."));
10243 return;
10244 }
10245
10246 pathname = tilde_expand (args);
10247 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
10248 fp = fopen (pathname, "w");
10249 if (!fp)
10250 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving tracepoints (%s)"),
10251 args, safe_strerror (errno));
10252 make_cleanup_fclose (fp);
10253
10254 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10255 {
10256 if (tp->addr_string)
10257 fprintf (fp, "trace %s\n", tp->addr_string);
10258 else
10259 {
10260 sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
10261 fprintf (fp, "trace *0x%s\n", tmp);
10262 }
10263
10264 if (tp->pass_count)
10265 fprintf (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
10266
10267 if (tp->actions)
10268 {
10269 fprintf (fp, " actions\n");
10270 indent = i1;
10271 for (line = tp->actions; line; line = line->next)
10272 {
10273 struct cmd_list_element *cmd;
10274
10275 QUIT; /* allow user to bail out with ^C */
10276 actionline = line->action;
10277 while (isspace ((int) *actionline))
10278 actionline++;
10279
10280 fprintf (fp, "%s%s\n", indent, actionline);
10281 if (*actionline != '#') /* skip for comment lines */
10282 {
10283 cmd = lookup_cmd (&actionline, cmdlist, "", -1, 1);
10284 if (cmd == 0)
10285 error (_("Bad action list item: %s"), actionline);
10286 if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, while_stepping_pseudocommand))
10287 indent = i2;
10288 else if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, end_actions_pseudocommand))
10289 indent = i1;
10290 }
10291 }
10292 }
10293 }
10294 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10295 if (from_tty)
10296 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoints saved to file '%s'.\n"), args);
10297 return;
10298 }
10299
10300 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
10301
10302 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
10303 all_tracepoints ()
10304 {
10305 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
10306 struct breakpoint *tp;
10307
10308 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10309 {
10310 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
10311 }
10312
10313 return tp_vec;
10314 }
10315
10316 \f
10317 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak commands.
10318 It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
10319 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the command. */
10320 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
10321 command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
10322 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10323 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
10324 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
10325 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
10326 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of selected stack frame.\n\
10327 This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
10328 \n\
10329 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
10330 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
10331 \n\
10332 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if conditional.\n\
10333 \n\
10334 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
10335
10336 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
10337 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
10338
10339 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
10340 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
10341
10342 /* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
10343 lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function. */
10344 static void
10345 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
10346 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
10347 struct cmd_list_element *command),
10348 char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
10349 char *text, char *word),
10350 void *user_data_catch,
10351 void *user_data_tcatch)
10352 {
10353 struct cmd_list_element *command;
10354
10355 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10356 &catch_cmdlist);
10357 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10358 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
10359 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10360
10361 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10362 &tcatch_cmdlist);
10363 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10364 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
10365 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10366 }
10367
10368 static void
10369 clear_syscall_counts (struct inferior *inf)
10370 {
10371 inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
10372 inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
10373 VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
10374 }
10375
10376 void
10377 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
10378 {
10379 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
10380 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
10381 struct cmd_list_element *c;
10382
10383 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
10384 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
10385 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
10386
10387 breakpoint_chain = 0;
10388 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
10389 before a breakpoint is set. */
10390 breakpoint_count = 0;
10391
10392 tracepoint_count = 0;
10393
10394 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
10395 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
10396 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
10397 if (xdb_commands)
10398 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
10399
10400 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
10401 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
10402 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
10403 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
10404 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
10405 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
10406 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
10407 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
10408
10409 add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
10410 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
10411 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
10412 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
10413
10414 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
10415 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
10416 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10417 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
10418 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
10419 \n"
10420 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
10421 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10422
10423 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
10424 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10425 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
10426 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
10427 \n"
10428 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
10429 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10430
10431 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
10432 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10433 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10434 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
10435 \n"
10436 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
10437 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10438
10439 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10440 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10441 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10442 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10443 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10444 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
10445 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10446 if (xdb_commands)
10447 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10448 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10449 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10450 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10451 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10452 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
10453
10454 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10455
10456 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10457 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10458 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10459 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10460 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
10461 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
10462
10463 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10464 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10465 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10466 &enablebreaklist);
10467
10468 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10469 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10470 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10471 &enablebreaklist);
10472
10473 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10474 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10475 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10476 &enablelist);
10477
10478 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10479 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10480 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10481 &enablelist);
10482
10483 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10484 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10485 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10486 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10487 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
10488 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10489 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10490 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10491 if (xdb_commands)
10492 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10493 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10494 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10495 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10496 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
10497
10498 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
10499 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10500 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10501 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10502 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
10503 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
10504 &disablelist);
10505
10506 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10507 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10508 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10509 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10510 \n\
10511 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
10512 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
10513 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
10514 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10515 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10516 if (xdb_commands)
10517 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10518 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
10519 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10520 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
10521
10522 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
10523 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10524 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10525 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10526 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
10527 &deletelist);
10528
10529 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
10530 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
10531 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10532 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
10533 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
10534 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
10535 \n\
10536 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
10537 is executing in.\n\
10538 \n\
10539 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
10540
10541 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
10542 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
10543 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
10544 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10545
10546 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
10547 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
10548 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
10549 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
10550
10551 if (xdb_commands)
10552 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
10553
10554 if (dbx_commands)
10555 {
10556 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
10557 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
10558 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
10559 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
10560 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
10561 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
10562 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
10563 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
10564 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10565 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10566 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10567 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10568 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10569 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10570 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10571 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10572 \n\
10573 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10574 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10575 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10576 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10577 breakpoint set."));
10578 }
10579
10580 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
10581 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10582 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10583 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10584 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10585 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10586 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10587 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10588 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10589 \n\
10590 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10591 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10592 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10593 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10594 breakpoint set."));
10595
10596 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
10597
10598 if (xdb_commands)
10599 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
10600 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10601 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10602 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10603 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10604 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10605 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10606 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10607 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10608 \n\
10609 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10610 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10611 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10612 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10613 breakpoint set."));
10614
10615 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
10616 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10617 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10618 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10619 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10620 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
10621 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
10622 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
10623 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
10624 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10625 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10626 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10627 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10628 \n\
10629 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10630 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10631 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10632 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10633 breakpoint set."),
10634 &maintenanceinfolist);
10635
10636 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
10637 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
10638 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
10639 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10640
10641 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
10642 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
10643 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
10644 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10645
10646 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
10647 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
10648 Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
10649 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10650 catch_catch_command,
10651 NULL,
10652 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10653 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10654 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
10655 Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
10656 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10657 catch_throw_command,
10658 NULL,
10659 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10660 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10661 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
10662 catch_fork_command_1,
10663 NULL,
10664 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
10665 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
10666 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
10667 catch_fork_command_1,
10668 NULL,
10669 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
10670 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
10671 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
10672 catch_exec_command_1,
10673 NULL,
10674 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10675 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10676 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
10677 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
10678 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
10679 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
10680 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
10681 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
10682 catch_syscall_command_1,
10683 catch_syscall_completer,
10684 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10685 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10686 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
10687 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
10688 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10689 catch_ada_exception_command,
10690 NULL,
10691 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10692 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10693 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
10694 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
10695 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10696 catch_assert_command,
10697 NULL,
10698 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10699 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10700
10701 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
10702 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10703 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10704 an expression changes."));
10705 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10706
10707 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
10708 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10709 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10710 an expression is read."));
10711 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10712
10713 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
10714 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10715 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10716 an expression is either read or written."));
10717 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10718
10719 add_info ("watchpoints", breakpoints_info,
10720 _("Synonym for ``info breakpoints''."));
10721
10722
10723 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
10724 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
10725 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
10726 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
10727 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10728 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10729 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
10730 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
10731 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
10732 hardware.)"),
10733 NULL,
10734 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
10735 &setlist, &showlist);
10736
10737 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
10738
10739 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
10740
10741 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
10742 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10743 \n"
10744 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
10745 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10746 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10747
10748 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
10749 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10750 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10751 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10752
10753 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
10754 Set a fast tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10755 \n"
10756 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
10757 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10758 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10759
10760 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
10761 Status of tracepoints, or tracepoint number NUMBER.\n\
10762 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
10763 last tracepoint set."));
10764
10765 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
10766
10767 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
10768 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
10769 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10770 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
10771 &deletelist);
10772
10773 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
10774 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
10775 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10776 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
10777 &disablelist);
10778 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
10779
10780 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
10781 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
10782 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10783 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
10784 &enablelist);
10785 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
10786
10787 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
10788 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
10789 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
10790 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
10791 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
10792
10793 c = add_com ("save-tracepoints", class_trace, tracepoint_save_command, _("\
10794 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
10795 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."));
10796 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
10797
10798 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10799 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10800 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10801 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10802 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
10803 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
10804 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10805 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10806 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10807 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10808 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
10809 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
10810
10811 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
10812 &pending_break_support, _("\
10813 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10814 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10815 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
10816 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
10817 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
10818 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
10819 NULL,
10820 show_pending_break_support,
10821 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10822 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10823
10824 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
10825
10826 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
10827 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
10828 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10829 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10830 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
10831 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
10832 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
10833 NULL,
10834 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
10835 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10836 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10837
10838 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
10839 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
10840 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10841 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10842 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
10843 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
10844 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
10845 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
10846 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
10847 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
10848 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
10849 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
10850 NULL,
10851 &show_always_inserted_mode,
10852 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10853 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10854
10855 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
10856
10857 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
10858 }